Bill Text: IN SB0115 | 2012 | Regular Session | Engrossed
Bill Title: Classification of political subdivisions.
Spectrum: Bipartisan Bill
Status: (Enrolled - Dead) 2012-03-19 - Signed by the Governor [SB0115 Detail]
Download: Indiana-2012-SB0115-Engrossed.html
Citations Affected: Numerous provisions throughout the Indiana
Code.
Effective: Upon passage; April 1, 2012; July 1, 2012.
(HOUSE SPONSORS _ KOCH, RICHARDSON)
January 4, 2012, read first time and referred to Committee on Elections.
January 9, 2012, amended, reported favorably _ Do Pass.
January 17, 2012, read second time, ordered engrossed.
January 18, 2012, engrossed.
January 23, 2012, read third time, passed. Yeas 50, nays 0.
January 31, 2012, read first time and referred to Committee on Elections and Apportionment.
February 20, 2012, amended, reported _ Do Pass.
Digest Continued
Substitutes names for population parameters in the following types of statutes: (1) Statutes legalizing certain actions of particular political subdivisions. (2) Statutes that have been challenged unsuccessfully as special or local legislation. (3) Statutes reserving certain powers to certain political subdivisions at the time of recodification of laws relating to political subdivisions. (4) Statutes relating to certain local taxes. Resolves a conflict in the statute that defines the classes of cities to provide that a city becomes a first class city when the city attains a population of 600,000. Allows a third class city that adopted second class city status as a result of the 2010 federal decennial census to adopt an ordinance or resolution to serve as the park authority and be subject to all or part of the provisions applicable to a park authority. Makes conforming amendments. (The introduced version of this bill was prepared by the census data advisory committee.)
PRINTING CODE. Amendments: Whenever an existing statute (or a section of the Indiana Constitution) is being amended, the text of the existing provision will appear in this style type, additions will appear in this style type, and deletions will appear in
Additions: Whenever a new statutory provision is being enacted (or a new constitutional provision adopted), the text of the new provision will appear in this style type. Also, the word NEW will appear in that style type in the introductory clause of each SECTION that adds a new provision to the Indiana Code or the Indiana Constitution.
Conflict reconciliation: Text in a statute in this style type or
A BILL FOR AN ACT to amend the Indiana Code concerning
general provisions.
(1) The SECTION amends a noncode statute or a provision of the Indiana Code.
(2) The SECTION takes effect before April 1, 2012.
(3) The SECTION contains an amendment to a population parameter.
The amendment to a population parameter in a SECTION described in this subsection takes effect April 1, 2012, and the amendment to other provisions in a SECTION described in this subsection take effect as otherwise provided in the bill described in this subsection.
(b) Notwithstanding any other bill enacted during the 2012 regular session of the Indiana general assembly, this subsection applies to each SECTION of each bill enacted during the 2012 regular session of the Indiana general assembly that satisfies all the following:
(1) The SECTION enacts a noncode statute or a new provision of the Indiana Code.
(2) The SECTION takes effect before April 1, 2012.
(3) The SECTION contains a population parameter.
Notwithstanding section 3 of this chapter, a population parameter in a SECTION described in this subsection refers to the population of the described political subdivisions as tabulated following the 2010 Decennial Census and delivered to the state by the United States Secretary of Commerce under 13 U.S.C. 141 and received by the governor during 2011.
(b) A county election board is not established in the following counties:
(1) A county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(1) Judge of a city court in a city located in a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(2) Judge of a town court.
(b) A person is not qualified to run for an office subject to this section unless not later than the deadline for filing the declaration or
petition of candidacy or certificate of nomination the person is
registered to vote in a county in which the municipality is located.
(b) A candidate for the office of judge of a city court must reside in the city upon filing any of the following:
(1) A declaration of candidacy or declaration of intent to be a write-in candidate required under IC 3-8-2.
(2) A petition of nomination under IC 3-8-6.
(3) A certificate of nomination under IC 3-10-6-12.
(c) A candidate for the office of judge of a city court must reside in a county in which the city is located upon the filing of a certificate of candidate selection under IC 3-13-1-15 or IC 3-13-2-8.
(d) This subsection applies to a candidate for the office of judge of a city court listed in IC 33-35-5-7(c). Before a candidate for the office of judge of the court may file a:
(1) declaration of candidacy or petition of nomination;
(2) certificate of candidate selection under IC 3-13-1-15 or IC 3-13-2-8; or
(3) declaration of intent to be a write-in candidate or certificate of nomination under IC 3-8-2-2.5 or IC 3-10-6-12;
the candidate must be an attorney in good standing admitted to the practice of law in Indiana.
(b) This section applies to a town that has not adopted an ordinance:
(1) under IC 18-3-1-16(b) (before its repeal on September 1, 1981); or
(2) in 1982 under P.L.13-1982, SECTION 3 (before its expiration on January 1, 1988).
(c) Notwithstanding IC 3-10-6-6, a town may adopt an ordinance during the year preceding a municipal election conducted under section 2 of this chapter prescribing the length of the term of office for town legislative body members elected in the municipal election.
(d) The ordinance must provide that:
(1) no more than fifty percent (50%) of the members will be elected for terms of three (3) years beginning at noon January 1 following the municipal election under section 2 of this chapter; and
(2) the remainder of the members will be elected for terms of four (4) years beginning at noon January 1 following the election.
(b) A town may adopt an ordinance under IC 3-10-6-2.5, if the town has not adopted an ordinance under IC 18-3-1-16(b) (before its repeal on September 1, 1981) or P.L.13-1982, SECTION 3 (before its expiration on January 1, 1988).
(b) An entity must apply for the loan before May 1, 1989, in a form approved by the state board of finance. As part of the application, the entity shall submit a plan for its use of the loan proceeds and for the repayment of the loan. Within sixty (60) days after receipt of each application, the board shall meet to consider the application and to review its accuracy and completeness and to determine the need for the loan. The board shall authorize a loan to an entity that makes an application if the board approves its accuracy and completeness and determines that there is a need for the loan and an adequate method of repayment.
(c) The state board of finance shall determine the terms of each loan, which must include the following:
(1) The duration of the loan, which must not exceed twelve (12) years.
(2) The repayment schedule of the loan, which must provide that no payments are due during the first two (2) years of the loan.
(3) A variable rate of interest to be determined by the board and adjusted annually. The interest rate must be the greater of:
(A) five percent (5%); or
(B) two-thirds (2/3) of the interest rate for fifty-two (52) week
United States Treasury bills on the anniversary date of the
loan, but not to exceed ten percent (10%).
(4) The amount of the loan or loans, which may not exceed the
maximum amounts established for the entity by this section.
(5) Any other conditions specified by the board.
(d) An entity may borrow money under this section by adoption of
an ordinance or a resolution and, as set forth in IC 5-1-14, may use any
source of revenue to repay a loan under this section. This section
constitutes complete authority for the entity to borrow from the fund.
If an entity described in subsection (i) fails to make any repayments of
a loan, the amount payable shall be withheld by the auditor of state
from any other money payable to the consolidated city. If any other
entity described in this section fails to make any repayments of a loan,
the amount payable shall be withheld by the auditor of state from any
other money payable to the entity. The amount withheld shall be
transferred to the fund to the credit of the entity.
(e) A loan under this section may be made to a city located in a
county having a population of more than twenty-four twenty-five
thousand (24,000) (25,000) but less than twenty-five thousand (25,000)
eight hundred (25,800) for the city's waterworks facility. The amount
of the loan may not exceed one million six hundred thousand dollars
($1,600,000).
(f) A loan under this section may be made to a city the territory of
which is included in part within the Lake Michigan corridor (as defined
in IC 14-13-3-2, before its repeal) for a marina development project. As
a part of its application under subsection (b), the city must include the
following:
(1) Written approval by the Lake Michigan marina development
commission of the project to be funded by the loan proceeds.
(2) A written determination by the commission of the amount
needed by the city, for the project and of the amount of the
maximum loan amount under this subsection that should be lent
to the city.
The maximum amount of loans available for all cities that are eligible
for a loan under this subsection is eight million six hundred thousand
dollars ($8,600,000).
(g) A loan under this section may be made to a county having a
population of more than one hundred seventy seventy-five thousand
(170,000) (175,000) but less than one hundred eighty eighty-five
thousand (180,000) (185,000) for use by the airport authority in the
county for the construction of runways. The amount of the loan may not
exceed seven million dollars ($7,000,000). The county may lend the
proceeds of its loan to an airport authority for the public purpose of
fostering economic growth in the county.
(h) A loan under this section may be made to a city having a
population of more than fifty-nine sixty thousand (59,000) (60,000) but
less than fifty-nine sixty-five thousand seven hundred (59,700)
(65,000) for the construction of parking facilities. The amount of the
loan may not exceed three million dollars ($3,000,000).
(i) A loan or loans under this section may be made to a consolidated
city, a local public improvement bond bank, or any board, authority, or
commission of the consolidated city to fund economic development
projects under IC 36-7-15.2-5 or to refund obligations issued to fund
economic development projects. The amount of the loan may not
exceed thirty million dollars ($30,000,000).
(j) A loan under this section may be made to a county having a
population of more than thirteen thousand five hundred (13,500)
(13,000) but less than fourteen thousand (14,000) for extension of
airport runways. The amount of the loan may not exceed three hundred
thousand dollars ($300,000).
(k) A loan under this section may be made to Covington Community
School Corporation to refund the amount due on a tax anticipation
warrant loan. The amount of the loan may not exceed two million seven
hundred thousand dollars ($2,700,000), to be paid back from any
source of money that is legally available to the school corporation.
Notwithstanding subsection (b), the school corporation must apply for
the loan before June 30, 2010. Notwithstanding subsection (c),
repayment of the loan shall be made in equal installments over five (5)
years with the first installment due not more than six (6) months after
the date loan proceeds are received by the school corporation.
(l) IC 6-1.1-20 does not apply to a loan made by an entity under this
section.
(m) As used in this section, "entity" means a governmental entity
authorized to obtain a loan under subsections (e) through (k).
(b) Except as provided by subsections (c) and (d) and IC 6-3.1-20-7, the treasurer of state shall quarterly pay the following amounts:
(1) Except as provided in subsection (k), one dollar ($1) of the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter or admitted to a riverboat that has implemented flexible scheduling
under IC 4-33-6-21 during the quarter shall be paid to:
(A) the city in which the riverboat is docked, if the city:
(i) is located in a county having a population of more than
one hundred ten eleven thousand (110,000) (111,000) but
less than one hundred fifteen thousand (115,000); or
(ii) is contiguous to the Ohio River and is the largest city in
the county; and
(B) the county in which the riverboat is docked, if the
riverboat is not docked in a city described in clause (A).
(2) Except as provided in subsection (k), one dollar ($1) of the
admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has
implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the county in which the riverboat is docked. In the
case of a county described in subdivision (1)(B), this one dollar
($1) is in addition to the one dollar ($1) received under
subdivision (1)(B).
(3) Except as provided in subsection (k), ten cents ($0.10) of the
admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has
implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the county convention and visitors bureau or
promotion fund for the county in which the riverboat is docked.
(4) Except as provided in subsection (k), fifteen cents ($0.15) of
the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each
person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during a quarter that has
implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the state fair commission, for use in any activity
that the commission is authorized to carry out under IC 15-13-3.
(5) Except as provided in subsection (k), ten cents ($0.10) of the
admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has
implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the division of mental health and addiction. The
division shall allocate at least twenty-five percent (25%) of the
funds derived from the admissions tax to the prevention and
treatment of compulsive gambling.
(6) Except as provided in subsection (k) and section 7 of this chapter, sixty-five cents ($0.65) of the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter or admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21 shall be paid to the Indiana horse racing commission to be distributed as follows, in amounts determined by the Indiana horse racing commission, for the promotion and operation of horse racing in Indiana:
(A) To one (1) or more breed development funds established by the Indiana horse racing commission under IC 4-31-11-10.
(B) To a racetrack that was approved by the Indiana horse racing commission under IC 4-31. The commission may make a grant under this clause only for purses, promotions, and routine operations of the racetrack. No grants shall be made for long term capital investment or construction, and no grants shall be made before the racetrack becomes operational and is offering a racing schedule.
(c) With respect to tax revenue collected from a riverboat located in a historic hotel district, the treasurer of state shall quarterly pay the following:
(1) With respect to admissions taxes collected for a person admitted to the riverboat before July 1, 2010, the following amounts:
(A) Twenty-two percent (22%) of the admissions tax collected during the quarter shall be paid to the county treasurer of the county in which the riverboat is located. The county treasurer shall distribute the money received under this clause as follows:
(i) Twenty-two and seventy-five hundredths percent (22.75%) shall be quarterly distributed to the county treasurer of a county having a population of more than
(ii) Twenty-two and seventy-five hundredths percent
(22.75%) shall be quarterly distributed to the county
treasurer of a county having a population of more than ten
thousand seven hundred (10,700) but less than twelve
thousand (12,000) for appropriation by the county fiscal
body. The county fiscal body for the receiving county shall
provide for the distribution of the money received under this
item to one (1) or more taxing units (as defined in
IC 6-1.1-1-21) in the county under a formula established by
the county fiscal body after receiving a recommendation
from the county executive.
(iii) Fifty-four and five-tenths percent (54.5%) shall be
retained by the county where the riverboat is located for
appropriation by the county fiscal body after receiving a
recommendation from the county executive.
(B) Five percent (5%) of the admissions tax collected during
the quarter shall be paid to a town having a population of more
than two thousand two hundred (2,200) (2,000) but less than
three thousand five hundred (3,500) located in a county having
a population of more than nineteen thousand three five
hundred (19,300) (19,500) but less than twenty thousand
(20,000). At least twenty percent (20%) of the taxes received
by a town under this clause must be transferred to the school
corporation in which the town is located.
(C) Five percent (5%) of the admissions tax collected during
the quarter shall be paid to a town having a population of more
than three thousand five hundred (3,500) located in a county
having a population of more than nineteen thousand three five
hundred (19,300) (19,500) but less than twenty thousand
(20,000). At least twenty percent (20%) of the taxes received
by a town under this clause must be transferred to the school
corporation in which the town is located.
(D) Twenty percent (20%) of the admissions tax collected
during the quarter shall be paid in equal amounts to each town
that:
(i) is located in the county in which the riverboat is located;
and
(ii) contains a historic hotel.
At least twenty percent (20%) of the taxes received by a town
under this clause must be transferred to the school corporation
in which the town is located.
(E) Ten percent (10%) of the admissions tax collected during
the quarter shall be paid to the Orange County development
commission established under IC 36-7-11.5. At least one-third
(1/3) of the taxes paid to the Orange County development
commission under this clause must be transferred to the
Orange County convention and visitors bureau.
(F) Thirteen percent (13%) of the admissions tax collected
during the quarter shall be paid to the West Baden Springs
historic hotel preservation and maintenance fund established
by IC 36-7-11.5-11(b).
(G) Twenty-five percent (25%) of the admissions tax collected
during the quarter shall be paid to the Indiana economic
development corporation to be used by the corporation for the
development and implementation of a regional economic
development strategy to assist the residents of the county in
which the riverboat is located and residents of contiguous
counties in improving their quality of life and to help promote
successful and sustainable communities. The regional
economic development strategy must include goals concerning
the following issues:
(i) Job creation and retention.
(ii) Infrastructure, including water, wastewater, and storm
water infrastructure needs.
(iii) Housing.
(iv) Workforce training.
(v) Health care.
(vi) Local planning.
(vii) Land use.
(viii) Assistance to regional economic development groups.
(ix) Other regional development issues as determined by the
Indiana economic development corporation.
(2) With respect to admissions taxes collected for a person
admitted to the riverboat after June 30, 2010, the following
amounts:
(A) Twenty-nine and thirty-three hundredths percent (29.33%)
to the county treasurer of Orange County. The county treasurer
shall distribute the money received under this clause as
follows:
(i) Twenty-two and seventy-five hundredths percent
(22.75%) to the county treasurer of Dubois County for
distribution in the manner described in subdivision
(1)(A)(i).
(ii) Twenty-two and seventy-five hundredths percent
(22.75%) to the county treasurer of Crawford County for
distribution in the manner described in subdivision
(1)(A)(ii).
(iii) Fifty-four and five-tenths percent (54.5%) to be retained
by the county treasurer of Orange County for appropriation
by the county fiscal body after receiving a recommendation
from the county executive.
(B) Six and sixty-seven hundredths percent (6.67%) to the
fiscal officer of the town of Orleans. At least twenty percent
(20%) of the taxes received by the town under this clause must
be transferred to Orleans Community Schools.
(C) Six and sixty-seven hundredths percent (6.67%) to the
fiscal officer of the town of Paoli. At least twenty percent
(20%) of the taxes received by the town under this clause must
be transferred to the Paoli Community School Corporation.
(D) Twenty-six and sixty-seven hundredths percent (26.67%)
to be paid in equal amounts to the fiscal officers of the towns
of French Lick and West Baden Springs. At least twenty
percent (20%) of the taxes received by a town under this
clause must be transferred to the Springs Valley Community
School Corporation.
(E) Thirty and sixty-six hundredths percent (30.66%) to the
Indiana economic development corporation to be used in the
manner described in subdivision (1)(G).
(d) With respect to tax revenue collected from a riverboat that
operates from a county having a population of more than four hundred
thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000),
the treasurer of state shall quarterly pay the following amounts:
(1) Except as provided in subsection (k), one dollar ($1) of the
admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has
implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the city in which the riverboat is docked.
(2) Except as provided in subsection (k), one dollar ($1) of the
admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has
implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the county in which the riverboat is docked.
(3) Except as provided in subsection (k), nine cents ($0.09) of the
admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the county convention and visitors bureau or promotion fund for the county in which the riverboat is docked.
(4) Except as provided in subsection (k), one cent ($0.01) of the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the northwest Indiana law enforcement training center.
(5) Except as provided in subsection (k), fifteen cents ($0.15) of the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during a quarter that has implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the state fair commission for use in any activity that the commission is authorized to carry out under IC 15-13-3.
(6) Except as provided in subsection (k), ten cents ($0.10) of the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person:
(A) embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter; or
(B) admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21;
shall be paid to the division of mental health and addiction. The division shall allocate at least twenty-five percent (25%) of the funds derived from the admissions tax to the prevention and treatment of compulsive gambling.
(7) Except as provided in subsection (k) and section 7 of this chapter, sixty-five cents ($0.65) of the admissions tax collected by the licensed owner for each person embarking on a gambling excursion during the quarter or admitted to a riverboat during the quarter that has implemented flexible scheduling under IC 4-33-6-21 shall be paid to the Indiana horse racing commission to be distributed as follows, in amounts determined by the Indiana horse racing commission, for the promotion and operation of horse racing in Indiana:
(A) To one (1) or more breed development funds established by the Indiana horse racing commission under IC 4-31-11-10.
(B) To a racetrack that was approved by the Indiana horse racing commission under IC 4-31. The commission may make a grant under this clause only for purses, promotions, and
routine operations of the racetrack. No grants shall be made
for long term capital investment or construction, and no grants
shall be made before the racetrack becomes operational and is
offering a racing schedule.
(e) Money paid to a unit of local government under subsection (b),
(c), or (d):
(1) must be paid to the fiscal officer of the unit and may be
deposited in the unit's general fund or riverboat fund established
under IC 36-1-8-9, or both;
(2) may not be used to reduce the unit's maximum levy under
IC 6-1.1-18.5 but may be used at the discretion of the unit to
reduce the property tax levy of the unit for a particular year;
(3) may be used for any legal or corporate purpose of the unit,
including the pledge of money to bonds, leases, or other
obligations under IC 5-1-14-4; and
(4) is considered miscellaneous revenue.
(f) Money paid by the treasurer of state under subsection (b)(3) or
(d)(3) shall be:
(1) deposited in:
(A) the county convention and visitor promotion fund; or
(B) the county's general fund if the county does not have a
convention and visitor promotion fund; and
(2) used only for the tourism promotion, advertising, and
economic development activities of the county and community.
(g) Money received by the division of mental health and addiction
under subsections (b)(5) and (d)(6):
(1) is annually appropriated to the division of mental health and
addiction;
(2) shall be distributed to the division of mental health and
addiction at times during each state fiscal year determined by the
budget agency; and
(3) shall be used by the division of mental health and addiction
for programs and facilities for the prevention and treatment of
addictions to drugs, alcohol, and compulsive gambling, including
the creation and maintenance of a toll free telephone line to
provide the public with information about these addictions. The
division shall allocate at least twenty-five percent (25%) of the
money received to the prevention and treatment of compulsive
gambling.
(h) This subsection applies to the following:
(1) Each entity receiving money under subsection (b).
(2) Each entity receiving money under subsection (d)(1) through
(d)(2).
(3) Each entity receiving money under subsection (d)(5) through
(d)(7).
The treasurer of state shall determine the total amount of money paid
by the treasurer of state to an entity subject to this subsection during
the state fiscal year 2002. The amount determined under this subsection
is the base year revenue for each entity subject to this subsection. The
treasurer of state shall certify the base year revenue determined under
this subsection to each entity subject to this subsection.
(i) This subsection applies to an entity receiving money under
subsection (d)(3) or (d)(4). The treasurer of state shall determine the
total amount of money paid by the treasurer of state to the entity
described in subsection (d)(3) during state fiscal year 2002. The
amount determined under this subsection multiplied by nine-tenths
(0.9) is the base year revenue for the entity described in subsection
(d)(3). The amount determined under this subsection multiplied by
one-tenth (0.1) is the base year revenue for the entity described in
subsection (d)(4). The treasurer of state shall certify the base year
revenue determined under this subsection to each entity subject to this
subsection.
(j) This subsection does not apply to an entity receiving money
under subsection (c). For state fiscal years beginning after June 30,
2002, the total amount of money distributed to an entity under this
section during a state fiscal year may not exceed the entity's base year
revenue as determined under subsection (h) or (i). If the treasurer of
state determines that the total amount of money distributed to an entity
under this section during a state fiscal year is less than the entity's base
year revenue, the treasurer of state shall make a supplemental
distribution to the entity under IC 4-33-13-5(g).
(k) This subsection does not apply to an entity receiving money
under subsection (c). For state fiscal years beginning after June 30,
2002, the treasurer of state shall pay that part of the riverboat
admissions taxes that:
(1) exceeds a particular entity's base year revenue; and
(2) would otherwise be due to the entity under this section;
to the state general fund instead of to the entity.
revenue deposited in the state gaming fund under this chapter to the
following:
(1) The first thirty-three million dollars ($33,000,000) of tax
revenues collected under this chapter shall be set aside for
revenue sharing under subsection (e).
(2) Subject to subsection (c), twenty-five percent (25%) of the
remaining tax revenue remitted by each licensed owner shall be
paid:
(A) to the city that is designated as the home dock of the
riverboat from which the tax revenue was collected, in the case
of:
(i) a city described in IC 4-33-12-6(b)(1)(A); or
(ii) a city located in a county having a population of more
than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven
hundred thousand (700,000); or
(B) to the county that is designated as the home dock of the
riverboat from which the tax revenue was collected, in the case
of a riverboat whose home dock is not in a city described in
clause (A).
(3) Subject to subsection (d), the remainder of the tax revenue
remitted by each licensed owner shall be paid to the state general
fund. In each state fiscal year, the treasurer of state shall make the
transfer required by this subdivision not later than the last
business day of the month in which the tax revenue is remitted to
the state for deposit in the state gaming fund. However, if tax
revenue is received by the state on the last business day in a
month, the treasurer of state may transfer the tax revenue to the
state general fund in the immediately following month.
(b) This subsection applies only to tax revenue remitted by an
operating agent operating a riverboat in a historic hotel district. After
funds are appropriated under section 4 of this chapter, each month the
treasurer of state shall distribute the tax revenue remitted by the
operating agent under this chapter as follows:
(1) Thirty-seven and one-half percent (37.5%) shall be paid to the
state general fund.
(2) Nineteen percent (19%) shall be paid to the West Baden
Springs historic hotel preservation and maintenance fund
established by IC 36-7-11.5-11(b). However, at any time the
balance in that fund exceeds twenty million dollars
($20,000,000), the amount described in this subdivision shall be
paid to the state general fund.
(3) Eight percent (8%) shall be paid to the Orange County
development commission established under IC 36-7-11.5.
(4) Sixteen percent (16%) shall be paid in equal amounts to each
town that is located in the county in which the riverboat is located
and contains a historic hotel. The following apply to taxes
received by a town under this subdivision:
(A) At least twenty-five percent (25%) of the taxes must be
transferred to the school corporation in which the town is
located.
(B) At least twelve and five-tenths percent (12.5%) of the
taxes imposed on adjusted gross receipts received after June
30, 2010, must be transferred to the Orange County
development commission established by IC 36-7-11.5-3.5.
(5) Nine percent (9%) shall be paid to the county treasurer of the
county in which the riverboat is located. The county treasurer
shall distribute the money received under this subdivision as
follows:
(A) Twenty-two and twenty-five hundredths percent (22.25%)
shall be quarterly distributed to the county treasurer of a
county having a population of more than thirty-nine forty
thousand six hundred (39,600) (40,000) but less than forty
forty-two thousand (40,000) (42,000) for appropriation by the
county fiscal body after receiving a recommendation from the
county executive. The county fiscal body for the receiving
county shall provide for the distribution of the money received
under this clause to one (1) or more taxing units (as defined in
IC 6-1.1-1-21) in the county under a formula established by
the county fiscal body after receiving a recommendation from
the county executive.
(B) Twenty-two and twenty-five hundredths percent (22.25%)
shall be quarterly distributed to the county treasurer of a
county having a population of more than ten thousand seven
hundred (10,700) but less than twelve thousand (12,000) for
appropriation by the county fiscal body after receiving a
recommendation from the county executive. The county fiscal
body for the receiving county shall provide for the distribution
of the money received under this clause to one (1) or more
taxing units (as defined in IC 6-1.1-1-21) in the county under
a formula established by the county fiscal body after receiving
a recommendation from the county executive.
(C) Fifty-five and five-tenths percent (55.5%) shall be retained
by the county in which the riverboat is located for
appropriation by the county fiscal body after receiving a
recommendation from the county executive.
(6) Five percent (5%) shall be paid to a town having a population
of more than two thousand two hundred (2,200) (2,000) but less
than three thousand five hundred (3,500) located in a county
having a population of more than nineteen thousand three five
hundred (19,300) (19,500) but less than twenty thousand
(20,000). At least forty percent (40%) of the taxes received by a
town under this subdivision must be transferred to the school
corporation in which the town is located.
(7) Five percent (5%) shall be paid to a town having a population
of more than three thousand five hundred (3,500) located in a
county having a population of more than nineteen thousand three
five hundred (19,300) (19,500) but less than twenty thousand
(20,000). At least forty percent (40%) of the taxes received by a
town under this subdivision must be transferred to the school
corporation in which the town is located.
(8) Five-tenths percent (0.5%) of the taxes imposed on adjusted
gross receipts received after June 30, 2010, shall be paid to the
Indiana economic development corporation established by
IC 5-28-3-1.
(c) For each city and county receiving money under subsection
(a)(2), the treasurer of state shall determine the total amount of money
paid by the treasurer of state to the city or county during the state fiscal
year 2002. The amount determined is the base year revenue for the city
or county. The treasurer of state shall certify the base year revenue
determined under this subsection to the city or county. The total
amount of money distributed to a city or county under this section
during a state fiscal year may not exceed the entity's base year revenue.
For each state fiscal year, the treasurer of state shall pay that part of the
riverboat wagering taxes that:
(1) exceeds a particular city's or county's base year revenue; and
(2) would otherwise be due to the city or county under this
section;
to the state general fund instead of to the city or county.
(d) Each state fiscal year the treasurer of state shall transfer from the
tax revenue remitted to the state general fund under subsection (a)(3)
to the build Indiana fund an amount that when added to the following
may not exceed two hundred fifty million dollars ($250,000,000):
(1) Surplus lottery revenues under IC 4-30-17-3.
(2) Surplus revenue from the charity gaming enforcement fund
under IC 4-32.2-7-7.
(3) Tax revenue from pari-mutuel wagering under IC 4-31-9-3.
The treasurer of state shall make transfers on a monthly basis as needed to meet the obligations of the build Indiana fund. If in any state fiscal year insufficient money is transferred to the state general fund under subsection (a)(3) to comply with this subsection, the treasurer of state shall reduce the amount transferred to the build Indiana fund to the amount available in the state general fund from the transfers under subsection (a)(3) for the state fiscal year.
(e) Before August 15 of each year, the treasurer of state shall distribute the wagering taxes set aside for revenue sharing under subsection (a)(1) to the county treasurer of each county that does not have a riverboat according to the ratio that the county's population bears to the total population of the counties that do not have a riverboat. Except as provided in subsection (h), the county auditor shall distribute the money received by the county under this subsection as follows:
(1) To each city located in the county according to the ratio the city's population bears to the total population of the county.
(2) To each town located in the county according to the ratio the town's population bears to the total population of the county.
(3) After the distributions required in subdivisions (1) and (2) are made, the remainder shall be retained by the county.
(f) Money received by a city, town, or county under subsection (e) or (h) may be used for any of the following purposes:
(1) To reduce the property tax levy of the city, town, or county for a particular year (a property tax reduction under this subdivision does not reduce the maximum levy of the city, town, or county under IC 6-1.1-18.5).
(2) For deposit in a special fund or allocation fund created under IC 8-22-3.5, IC 36-7-14, IC 36-7-14.5, IC 36-7-15.1, and IC 36-7-30 to provide funding for debt repayment.
(3) To fund sewer and water projects, including storm water management projects.
(4) For police and fire pensions.
(5) To carry out any governmental purpose for which the money is appropriated by the fiscal body of the city, town, or county. Money used under this subdivision does not reduce the property tax levy of the city, town, or county for a particular year or reduce the maximum levy of the city, town, or county under IC 6-1.1-18.5.
(g) This subsection does not apply to an entity receiving money under IC 4-33-12-6(c). Before September 15 of each year, the treasurer of state shall determine the total amount of money distributed to an
entity under IC 4-33-12-6 during the preceding state fiscal year. If the
treasurer of state determines that the total amount of money distributed
to an entity under IC 4-33-12-6 during the preceding state fiscal year
was less than the entity's base year revenue (as determined under
IC 4-33-12-6), the treasurer of state shall make a supplemental
distribution to the entity from taxes collected under this chapter and
deposited into the state general fund. Except as provided in subsection
(i), the amount of an entity's supplemental distribution is equal to:
(1) the entity's base year revenue (as determined under
IC 4-33-12-6); minus
(2) the sum of:
(A) the total amount of money distributed to the entity during
the preceding state fiscal year under IC 4-33-12-6; plus
(B) any amounts deducted under IC 6-3.1-20-7.
(h) This subsection applies only to a county containing a
consolidated city. The county auditor shall distribute the money
received by the county under subsection (e) as follows:
(1) To each city, other than a consolidated city, located in the
county according to the ratio that the city's population bears to the
total population of the county.
(2) To each town located in the county according to the ratio that
the town's population bears to the total population of the county.
(3) After the distributions required in subdivisions (1) and (2) are
made, the remainder shall be paid in equal amounts to the
consolidated city and the county.
(i) This subsection applies only to the Indiana horse racing
commission. For each state fiscal year the amount of the Indiana horse
racing commission's supplemental distribution under subsection (g)
must be reduced by the amount required to comply with
IC 4-33-12-7(a).
(1) each county having a population of more than one hundred
(2) each second class city located in
(b) As used in this section, "stadium" means a structure used for athletic, recreational, cultural, and community events.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, a stadium constitutes a:
(1) government building under IC 36-9-13;
(2) structure under IC 36-1-10;
(3) park purpose under IC 36-10-1;
(4) park improvement under IC 36-10-4; and
(5) redevelopment project or purpose under IC 36-7-14.
(d) Notwithstanding any other law, a legislative body of a city may levy a tax in the park district established under IC 36-10-4 to pay lease rentals to a lessor of a stadium under IC 36-1-10 or IC 36-9-13.
(1) A consolidated city.
(2) A
(3) A city having a population of more than
(1) A city.
(2) A county.
(3) A special taxing district located wholly within a county.
(4) Any entity whose tax levies are subject to review and modification by a city-county legislative body under IC 36-3-6-9.
(5) A political subdivision (as defined in IC 36-1-2-13) that is located wholly within a county:
(A) that has a population of:
(i) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(ii) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(B) containing a city that:
(i) is described in section 5(3) of this chapter; and
(ii) has a public improvement bond bank under this article.
(6) A charter school established under IC 20-24 that is sponsored by the executive of a consolidated city.
(7) Any authority created under IC 36 that leases land or facilities to any qualified entity listed in subdivisions (1) through (6).
(1) legally qualified and regularly employed teachers in the public schools;
(2) persons employed by a governing body, who were qualified before their election or appointment;
(3) legally qualified and regularly employed teachers at Ball State University, Indiana State University, University of Southern Indiana, and Vincennes University;
(4) legally qualified and regularly employed teachers in a state educational institution whose teachers devote their entire time to teaching;
(5) legally qualified and regularly employed teachers in state benevolent, charitable, or correctional institutions;
(6) legally qualified and regularly employed teachers in an experimental school in a state university who teach elementary or high school students;
(7) as determined by the board, certain instructors serving in a state educational institution extension division not covered by a state retirement law;
(8) employees and officers of the department of education and of the fund who were qualified before their election or appointment;
(9) a person who:
(A) is employed as a nurse appointed under IC 20-34-3-6 by a school corporation located in a city having a population of more than
(B) participated in the fund before December 31, 1991, in the position described in clause (A); and
(10) persons who are employed by the fund.
(b) Teachers in any state institution who accept the benefits of a state supported retirement benefit system comparable to the fund's benefits may not come under the fund unless permitted by law or the rules of the board.
(c) The members of the fund do not include substitute teachers who have not obtained an associate degree or a baccalaureate degree.
(1) Securities backed by the full faith and credit of the United States Treasury or fully guaranteed by the United States and
issued by any of the following:
(A) The United States Treasury.
(B) A federal agency.
(C) A federal instrumentality.
(D) A federal government sponsored enterprise.
(2) Securities fully guaranteed and issued by any of the following:
(A) A federal agency.
(B) A federal instrumentality.
(C) A federal government sponsored enterprise.
(3) Municipal securities issued by an Indiana local governmental
entity, a quasi-governmental entity related to the state, or a unit of
government, municipal corporation, or special taxing district in
Indiana, if the issuer has not defaulted on any of the issuer's
obligations within the twenty (20) years preceding the date of the
purchase.
(b) If an investment under subsection (a)(1) is made at a cost in
excess of the par value of the securities purchased, any premium paid
for the securities shall be deducted from the first interest received and
returned to the fund from which the investment was purchased, and
only the net amount is considered interest income.
(c) The officer making the investment may sell any securities
acquired and may do anything necessary to protect the interests of the
funds invested, including the exercise of exchange privileges which
may be granted with respect to maturing securities in cases where the
new securities offered in exchange meet the requirements for initial
investment.
(d) The investing officers of the political subdivisions are the legal
custodians of securities under this chapter. They shall accept
safekeeping receipts or other reporting for securities from:
(1) a duly designated depository as prescribed in this article; or
(2) a financial institution located either in or out of Indiana having
custody of securities with a combined capital and surplus of at
least ten million dollars ($10,000,000) according to the last
statement of condition filed by the financial institution with its
governmental supervisory body.
(e) The state board of accounts may rely on safekeeping receipts or
other reporting from any depository or financial institution.
(f) In addition to any other investments allowed under this chapter,
an officer of a conservancy district located in a city having a population
of more than four five thousand six hundred fifty (4,650) (5,000) but
less than five thousand (5,000) one hundred (5,100) may also invest
in:
(1) municipal securities; and
(2) equity securities;
having a stated final maturity of any number of years or having no stated final maturity. The total investments outstanding under this subsection may not exceed twenty-five percent (25%) of the total portfolio of funds invested by the officer of a conservancy district. However, an investment that complies with this subsection when the investment is made remains legal even if a subsequent decrease in the total portfolio invested by the officer of a conservancy district causes the percentage of investments outstanding under this subsection to exceed twenty-five percent (25%).
(g) In addition to any other investments allowed under this chapter, a clerk-treasurer of a town with a population of more than
(1) municipal securities; and
(2) equity securities;
having a stated final maturity of any number of years or having no stated final maturity. The total investments outstanding under this subsection may not exceed twenty-five percent (25%) of the total portfolio of funds invested by the clerk-treasurer of a town. However, an investment that complies with this subsection when the investment is made remains legal even if a subsequent decrease in the total portfolio invested by the clerk-treasurer of a town causes the percentage of investments outstanding under this subsection to exceed twenty-five percent (25%).
(1) five (5) years for a conservancy district located in a city having a population of more than
(2) five (5) years for investments made from a host community agreement future fund established by ordinance of a town with a population of more than
(5,000) but less than ten thousand (10,000) located in a county
having a population of more than one hundred forty thousand
(100,000) (140,000) but less than one hundred five fifty thousand
(105,000); (150,000); or
(3) two (2) years for a fund or political subdivision not described
in subdivision (1) or (2);
after the date of purchase or entry into a repurchase agreement.
(1) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(2) more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000);
may claim an exemption for commercial passenger aircraft not subject to the aircraft excise tax under IC 6-6-6.5 that is being assessed under this article, if it is located in the county only for the purposes of maintenance.
(b) The exemption provided by this section is noncumulative and applies only to property that would not otherwise be exempt. Nothing contained in this section applies to or affects any other tax exemption provided by law.
(c) As used in this section, "land used for public airport purposes" includes the following:
(1) That part of airport land used for the taking off or landing of aircraft, taxiways, runway and taxiway lighting, access roads, auto and aircraft parking areas, and all buildings providing basic facilities for the traveling public.
(2) Real property owned by the airport owner and used directly for airport operation and maintenance purposes.
(3) Real property used in providing for the shelter, storage, or care of aircraft, including hangars.
(4) Housing for weather and signaling equipment, navigational aids, radios, or other electronic equipment.
The term does not include land areas used solely for purposes unrelated to aviation.
(1) A county having a population of more than twenty thousand (20,000) but less than twenty thousand
(2) A county having a population of more than
(b) A tract of real property owned by a nonprofit public benefit corporation (as defined in IC 23-17-2-23) is exempt from property taxation if all of the following apply:
(1) The tract is located:
(A) under a lake or reservoir; or
(B) adjacent to a lake or reservoir.
(2) The lake or reservoir under which or adjacent to which the tract is located was formed by a dam or control structure owned and operated by a public utility for the generation of hydroelectric power.
(3) The public benefit corporation that owns the tract is exempt from federal income taxation under Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code and has maintained its tax exempt status for the previous three (3) years.
(4) The public benefit corporation that owns the tract is primarily engaged in active efforts to protect and enhance the environment and water quality of the lake or reservoir under which or adjacent to which the tract is located in order to facilitate the public recreational use of the lake or reservoir.
(c) A tract of real property owned by a nonprofit public benefit corporation described in subsection (b) is exempt from property taxation if the tract is used by the public benefit corporation in the public benefit corporation's efforts to enhance the environment and water quality of a lake or reservoir described in subsection (b).
(b) In a county containing a consolidated city or within a city or town, a designating body may find that a particular area within its jurisdiction is a residentially distressed area. Designation of an area as a residentially distressed area has the same effect as designating an area as an economic revitalization area, except that the amount of the deduction shall be calculated as specified in section 4.1 of this chapter and the deduction is allowed for not more than five (5) years. In order to declare a particular area a residentially distressed area, the designating body must follow the same procedure that is required to designate an area as an economic revitalization area and must make all the following additional findings or all the additional findings described in subsection (c):
(1) The area is comprised of parcels that are either unimproved or contain only one (1) or two (2) family dwellings or multifamily dwellings designed for up to four (4) families, including accessory buildings for those dwellings.
(2) Any dwellings in the area are not permanently occupied and are:
(A) the subject of an order issued under IC 36-7-9; or
(B) evidencing significant building deficiencies.
(3) Parcels of property in the area:
(A) have been sold and not redeemed under IC 6-1.1-24 and IC 6-1.1-25; or
(B) are owned by a unit of local government.
However, in a city in a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(c) In a county containing a consolidated city or within a city or town, a designating body that wishes to designate a particular area a residentially distressed area may make the following additional findings as an alternative to the additional findings described in subsection (b):
(1) A significant number of dwelling units within the area are not permanently occupied or a significant number of parcels in the area are vacant land.
(2) A significant number of dwelling units within the area are:
(A) the subject of an order issued under IC 36-7-9; or
(B) evidencing significant building deficiencies.
(3) The area has experienced a net loss in the number of dwelling
units, as documented by census information, local building and
demolition permits, or certificates of occupancy, or the area is
owned by Indiana or the United States.
(4) The area (plus any areas previously designated under this
subsection) will not exceed ten percent (10%) of the total area
within the designating body's jurisdiction.
However, in a city in a county having a population of more than two
hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two
hundred seventy thousand (300,000), (270,000), the designating body
is only required to make one (1) of the additional findings described in
this subsection as an alternative to one (1) of the additional findings
described in subsection (b).
(d) A designating body is required to attach the following conditions
to the grant of a residentially distressed area designation:
(1) The deduction will not be allowed unless the dwelling is
rehabilitated to meet local code standards for habitability.
(2) If a designation application is filed, the designating body may
require that the redevelopment or rehabilitation be completed
within a reasonable period of time.
(e) To make a designation described in subsection (a) or (b), the
designating body shall use procedures prescribed in section 2.5 of this
chapter.
(f) The property tax deductions provided by section 3, 4.5, or 4.8 of
this chapter are only available within an area which the designating
body finds to be an economic revitalization area.
(g) The designating body may adopt a resolution establishing
general standards to be used, along with the requirements set forth in
the definition of economic revitalization area, by the designating body
in finding an area to be an economic revitalization area. The standards
must have a reasonable relationship to the development objectives of
the area in which the designating body has jurisdiction. The following
four (4) sets of standards may be established:
(1) One (1) relative to the deduction under section 3 of this
chapter for economic revitalization areas that are not residentially
distressed areas.
(2) One (1) relative to the deduction under section 3 of this
chapter for residentially distressed areas.
(3) One (1) relative to the deduction allowed under section 4.5 of
this chapter.
(4) One (1) relative to the deduction allowed under section 4.8 of
this chapter.
(h) A designating body may impose a fee for filing a designation
application for a person requesting the designation of a particular area
as an economic revitalization area. The fee may be sufficient to defray
actual processing and administrative costs. However, the fee charged
for filing a designation application for a parcel that contains one (1) or
more owner-occupied, single-family dwellings may not exceed the cost
of publishing the required notice.
(i) In declaring an area an economic revitalization area, the
designating body may:
(1) limit the time period to a certain number of calendar years
during which the economic revitalization area shall be so
designated;
(2) limit the type of deductions that will be allowed within the
economic revitalization area to the deduction allowed under
section 3 of this chapter, the deduction allowed under section 4.5
of this chapter, the deduction allowed under section 4.8 of this
chapter, or any combination of these deductions;
(3) limit the dollar amount of the deduction that will be allowed
with respect to new manufacturing equipment, new research and
development equipment, new logistical distribution equipment,
and new information technology equipment if a deduction under
this chapter had not been filed before July 1, 1987, for that
equipment;
(4) limit the dollar amount of the deduction that will be allowed
with respect to redevelopment and rehabilitation occurring in
areas that are designated as economic revitalization areas on or
after September 1, 1988;
(5) limit the dollar amount of the deduction that will be allowed
under section 4.8 of this chapter with respect to the occupation of
an eligible vacant building; or
(6) impose reasonable conditions related to the purpose of this
chapter or to the general standards adopted under subsection (g)
for allowing the deduction for the redevelopment or rehabilitation
of the property or the installation of the new manufacturing
equipment, new research and development equipment, new
logistical distribution equipment, or new information technology
equipment.
To exercise one (1) or more of these powers, a designating body must
include this fact in the resolution passed under section 2.5 of this
chapter.
(j) Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter, if a
designating body limits the time period during which an area is an
economic revitalization area, that limitation does not:
(1) prevent a taxpayer from obtaining a deduction for new manufacturing equipment, new research and development equipment, new logistical distribution equipment, or new information technology equipment installed on or before the approval deadline determined under section 9 of this chapter, but after the expiration of the economic revitalization area if:
(A) the economic revitalization area designation expires after December 30, 1995; and
(B) the new manufacturing equipment, new research and development equipment, new logistical distribution equipment, or new information technology equipment was described in a statement of benefits submitted to and approved by the designating body in accordance with section 4.5 of this chapter before the expiration of the economic revitalization area designation; or
(2) limit the length of time a taxpayer is entitled to receive a deduction to a number of years that is less than the number of years designated under section 4, 4.5, or 4.8 of this chapter.
(k) Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter, deductions:
(1) that are authorized under section 3 of this chapter for property in an area designated as an urban development area before March 1, 1983, and that are based on an increase in assessed valuation resulting from redevelopment or rehabilitation that occurs before March 1, 1983; or
(2) that are authorized under section 4.5 of this chapter for new manufacturing equipment installed in an area designated as an urban development area before March 1, 1983;
apply according to the provisions of this chapter as they existed at the time that an application for the deduction was first made. No deduction that is based on the location of property or new manufacturing equipment in an urban development area is authorized under this chapter after February 28, 1983, unless the initial increase in assessed value resulting from the redevelopment or rehabilitation of the property or the installation of the new manufacturing equipment occurred before March 1, 1983.
(l) In addition to the other requirements of this chapter, if property located in an economic revitalization area is also located in an allocation area (as defined in IC 36-7-14-39 or IC 36-7-15.1-26), a taxpayer's statement of benefits concerning that property may not be approved under this chapter unless a resolution approving the statement of benefits is adopted by the legislative body of the unit that approved the designation of the allocation area.
(1) A description of the proposed redevelopment or rehabilitation.
(2) An estimate of the number of individuals who will be employed or whose employment will be retained by the person as a result of the redevelopment or rehabilitation and an estimate of the annual salaries of these individuals.
(3) An estimate of the value of the redevelopment or rehabilitation.
With the approval of the designating body, the statement of benefits may be incorporated in a designation application. Notwithstanding any other law, a statement of benefits is a public record that may be inspected and copied under IC 5-14-3-3.
(b) The designating body must review the statement of benefits required under subsection (a). The designating body shall determine whether an area should be designated an economic revitalization area or whether a deduction should be allowed, based on (and after it has made) the following findings:
(1) Whether the estimate of the value of the redevelopment or rehabilitation is reasonable for projects of that nature.
(2) Whether the estimate of the number of individuals who will be employed or whose employment will be retained can be reasonably expected to result from the proposed described redevelopment or rehabilitation.
(3) Whether the estimate of the annual salaries of those individuals who will be employed or whose employment will be retained can be reasonably expected to result from the proposed described redevelopment or rehabilitation.
(4) Whether any other benefits about which information was requested are benefits that can be reasonably expected to result
from the proposed described redevelopment or rehabilitation.
(5) Whether the totality of benefits is sufficient to justify the
deduction.
A designating body may not designate an area an economic
revitalization area or approve a deduction unless the findings required
by this subsection are made in the affirmative.
(c) Except as provided in subsections (a) through (b), the owner of
property which is located in an economic revitalization area is entitled
to a deduction from the assessed value of the property. If the area is a
residentially distressed area, the period is not more than five (5) years.
For all other economic revitalization areas designated before July 1,
2000, the period is three (3), six (6), or ten (10) years. For all economic
revitalization areas designated after June 30, 2000, the period is the
number of years determined under subsection (d). The owner is entitled
to a deduction if:
(1) the property has been rehabilitated; or
(2) the property is located on real estate which has been
redeveloped.
The owner is entitled to the deduction for the first year, and any
successive year or years, in which an increase in assessed value
resulting from the rehabilitation or redevelopment occurs and for the
following years determined under subsection (d). However, property
owners who had an area designated an urban development area
pursuant to an application filed prior to January 1, 1979, are only
entitled to a deduction for a five (5) year period. In addition, property
owners who are entitled to a deduction under this chapter pursuant to
an application filed after December 31, 1978, and before January 1,
1986, are entitled to a deduction for a ten (10) year period.
(d) For an area designated as an economic revitalization area after
June 30, 2000, that is not a residentially distressed area, the designating
body shall determine the number of years for which the property owner
is entitled to a deduction. However, the deduction may not be allowed
for more than ten (10) years. This determination shall be made:
(1) as part of the resolution adopted under section 2.5 of this
chapter; or
(2) by resolution adopted within sixty (60) days after receiving a
copy of a property owner's certified deduction application from
the county auditor. A certified copy of the resolution shall be sent
to the county auditor who shall make the deduction as provided
in section 5 of this chapter.
A determination about the number of years the deduction is allowed
that is made under subdivision (1) is final and may not be changed by
following the procedure under subdivision (2).
(e) Except for deductions related to redevelopment or rehabilitation
of real property in a county containing a consolidated city or a
deduction related to redevelopment or rehabilitation of real property
initiated before December 31, 1987, in areas designated as economic
revitalization areas before that date, a deduction for the redevelopment
or rehabilitation of real property may not be approved for the following
facilities:
(1) Private or commercial golf course.
(2) Country club.
(3) Massage parlor.
(4) Tennis club.
(5) Skating facility (including roller skating, skateboarding, or ice
skating).
(6) Racquet sport facility (including any handball or racquetball
court).
(7) Hot tub facility.
(8) Suntan facility.
(9) Racetrack.
(10) Any facility the primary purpose of which is:
(A) retail food and beverage service;
(B) automobile sales or service; or
(C) other retail;
unless the facility is located in an economic development target
area established under section 7 of this chapter.
(11) Residential, unless:
(A) the facility is a multifamily facility that contains at least
twenty percent (20%) of the units available for use by low and
moderate income individuals;
(B) the facility is located in an economic development target
area established under section 7 of this chapter; or
(C) the area is designated as a residentially distressed area.
(12) A package liquor store that holds a liquor dealer's permit
under IC 7.1-3-10 or any other entity that is required to operate
under a license issued under IC 7.1. This subdivision does not
apply to an applicant that:
(A) was eligible for tax abatement under this chapter before
July 1, 1995;
(B) is described in IC 7.1-5-7-11; or
(C) operates a facility under:
(i) a beer wholesaler's permit under IC 7.1-3-3;
(ii) a liquor wholesaler's permit under IC 7.1-3-8; or
(iii) a wine wholesaler's permit under IC 7.1-3-13;
for which the applicant claims a deduction under this chapter.
(b) Section 4.5(e) of this chapter does not apply to new manufacturing equipment located in a county having a population of more than
(1) the total original cost of all new manufacturing equipment placed into service in the county by the owner exceeds five hundred million dollars ($500,000,000); and
(2) the economic revitalization area in which the new manufacturing equipment was installed was approved by the designating body before January 1, 2001.
(c) A deduction under section 4.5(c) of this chapter is not allowed with respect to new manufacturing equipment described in subsection (b) in the first year the deduction is claimed or in subsequent years as permitted by section 4.5(c) of this chapter to the extent the deduction would cause the assessed value of all real property and personal property of the owner in the taxing district to be less than the incremental net assessed value for that year.
(d) The following apply for purposes of subsection (c):
(1) A deduction under section 4.5(c) of this chapter shall be disallowed only with respect to new manufacturing equipment installed after March 1, 2000.
(2) "Incremental net assessed value" means the sum of:
(A) the net assessed value of real property and depreciable personal property from which property tax revenues are required to be held in trust and pledged for the benefit of the owners of bonds issued by the redevelopment commission of a county described in subsection (b) under resolutions adopted November 16, 1998, and July 13, 2000 (as amended November 27, 2000); plus
(B) fifty-four million four hundred eighty-one thousand seven hundred seventy dollars ($54,481,770).
(3) The assessed value of real property and personal property of the owner shall be determined after the deductions provided by sections 3 and 4.5 of this chapter.
(4) The personal property of the owner shall include inventory.
(5) The amount of deductions provided by section 4.5 of this chapter with respect to new manufacturing equipment that was installed on or before March 1, 2000, shall be increased from thirty-three and one-third percent (33 1/3%) of true tax value to one hundred percent (100%) of true tax value for assessment dates after February 28, 2001.
(e) A deduction not fully allowed under subsection (c) in the first year the deduction is claimed or in a subsequent year permitted by section 4.5 of this chapter shall be carried over and allowed as a deduction in succeeding years. A deduction that is carried over to a year but is not allowed in that year under this subsection shall be carried over and allowed as a deduction in succeeding years. The following apply for purposes of this subsection:
(1) A deduction that is carried over to a succeeding year is not allowed in that year to the extent that the deduction, together with:
(A) deductions otherwise allowed under section 3 of this
chapter;
(B) deductions otherwise allowed under section 4.5 of this
chapter; and
(C) other deductions carried over to the year under this
subsection;
would cause the assessed value of all real property and personal
property of the owner in the taxing district to be less than the
incremental net assessed value for that year.
(2) Each time a deduction is carried over to a succeeding year, the
deduction shall be reduced by the amount of the deduction that
was allowed in the immediately preceding year.
(3) A deduction may not be carried over to a succeeding year
under this subsection if such year is after the period specified in
section 4.5(c) of this chapter or the period specified in a
resolution adopted by the designating body under section 4.5(g)
of this chapter.
(b) Notwithstanding sections 3 and 4.5 of this chapter, the submission of a statement of benefits to a designating body subsequent to the installation of new manufacturing equipment and the initiation of the rehabilitation or redevelopment of real estate and the designating body's retroactive approval of that statement of benefits are legalized and validated for 1993 and subsequent assessment years, subject to the limitations set forth in section 5(e) of this chapter.
(b) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's actions taken after September 1, 1992, and before December 31, 1993, in:
(1) designating an economic revitalization area; or
(2) approving a statement of benefits after the initiation of the
installation of new manufacturing equipment for which the person
desires to claim a deduction under this chapter;
are legalized and validated.
(1) was initiated after January 1, 1993, and before January 1, 1994; and
(2) is in
(b) The definitions in IC 6-1.1-12.1-1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) apply throughout this section.
(c) Notwithstanding section IC 6-1.1-12.1-3 (as in effect before May 10, 1995), the:
(1) designation or enlargement of an economic revitalization area;
(2) submission of a statement of benefits; and
(3) designating body's approval of the statement of benefits;
after the initiation of the rehabilitation or redevelopment for which a deduction is claimed under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) are legalized and validated for deductions claimed for 1994 and subsequent assessment years.
(b) The definitions in IC 6-1.1-12.1-1 (as in effect before December 31, 1992) apply throughout this section.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's actions taken before May 31, 1992, in designating an economic revitalization area are legalized and validated.
(d) The installation of new manufacturing equipment after March 1, 1991, is eligible for the deduction provided under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before December 31, 1992) for property taxes first due and
payable after December 31, 1992, as granted by resolution adopted by
the designating body for the economic revitalization area.
(1) is located in an economic revitalization area declared under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before December 31, 1992) in
(2) with respect to new manufacturing equipment installed by the taxpayer in the economic revitalization area after March 2, 1991, and before March 1, 1992, filed a statement of benefits under IC 6-1.1-12.1-4.5 (as in effect before December 31, 1992) after March 1, 1992, with the designating body for the economic revitalization area.
(b) The definitions in IC 6-1.1-12.1-1 (as in effect before December 31, 1992) apply throughout this section.
(c) Notwithstanding IC 6-1.1-12.1-4.5 (as in effect before December 31, 1992), a statement of benefits is not required of a taxpayer to qualify for the economic revitalization area deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before December 31, 1992) with respect to the new manufacturing equipment described in subsection (a).
(d) This section applies to property taxes due and payable after December 31, 1992.
(b) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's actions taken after July 1, 1991, and before December 31, 1992, in:
(1) designating an economic revitalization area; or
(2) approving a statement of benefits;
after the initiation of the installation of new manufacturing equipment for which a person desires to claim a deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as
in effect before May 10, 1995) are legalized and validated.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's actions
taken after February 28, 1993, and before July 1, 1995:
(1) designating an economic revitalization area;
(2) approving a statement of benefits; or
(3) retroactively approving a statement of benefits;
after initiation of the installation of new manufacturing equipment or
rehabilitation or redevelopment of real property for which a person
desires to claim a deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before
May 10, 1995) are legalized and validated.
(d) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's action taken
after February 28, 1993, and before July 1, 1995, incorporating the
information required in the statement of benefits in the designating
body's findings of fact made in support of designating an area as an
economic revitalization area or approving a deduction under
IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) is legalized and
validated and shall be treated as if the applicant provided the statement
of benefits before the final action taken by the designating body.
(e) Notwithstanding any other law, a review shall be made of timely
filed deduction applications for actions legalized and validated under
this section for the purpose of granting deductions under IC 6-1.1-12.1
(as in effect before May 10, 1995) for assessment years after 1991.
(b) The definitions in IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before January 1, 1994) apply throughout this section.
(c) A taxpayer that is otherwise eligible for a tax deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before January 1, 1994) but failed to:
(1) designate or expand the boundaries of an economic revitalization area;
(2) file a statement of benefits or other information with the designating body;
(3) have a statement of benefits approved by a designating body;
(4) have a deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before January 1, 1994) granted by a designating body; or
(5) have the designating body make the findings of fact required under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before January 1, 1994);
before installing new manufacturing equipment or initiating redevelopment or rehabilitation in an economic revitalization area is entitled to a tax deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before January 1, 1994) on property for assessment years after 1993 to the same extent as if the taxpayer had installed new manufacturing equipment or initiated redevelopment or rehabilitation after the actions described in subdivisions (1) through (5).
(d) The state board of tax commissioners and the county auditor in the county where the property is located shall approve the taxpayer's application for a deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before January 1, 1994) on the property as soon as feasible after May 10, 1995.
(e) This section applies only to property taxes first due and payable after 1994.
(b) The definitions in IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) apply throughout this section.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's actions taken after July 1, 1991, and before December 31, 1992, in:
(1) designating an economic revitalization area; or
(2) approving a statement of benefits;
after the initiation of the installation of new manufacturing equipment for which a person desires to claim a deduction under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) are legalized and validated.
(d) Notwithstanding any other law, a review shall be made of timely filed deduction applications for actions legalized and validated under this section for the purpose of granting deductions under IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) for assessment years after 1991.
Benton County. having a population:
(1) of more than nine thousand (9,000) but less than nine
thousand five hundred (9,500); and
(2) as determined by the 1990 federal decennial census.
(b) The definitions in IC 6-1.1-12.1-1 (as in effect before May 10,
1995) apply throughout this section.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, a designating body's actions
taken before December 31, 1994, in:
(1) designating an economic revitalization area; or
(2) approving a statement of benefits;
after the initiation of the installation of new manufacturing equipment
or after the initiation of the rehabilitation or redevelopment of real
estate for which a person desires to claim a deduction under
IC 6-1.1-12.1 (as in effect before May 10, 1995) are legalized and
validated.
(1) The board of school trustees of a school corporation that is located in a city having a population of more than one hundred
(A) the time required in section 5.6(b) of this chapter; or
(B) November 1 if a resolution adopted under section 5.6(d) of this chapter is in effect.
(2) The proper officers of all other political subdivisions that are not school corporations, not later than November 1.
(3) The governing body of a school corporation (other than a school corporation described in subdivision (1)) that elects to adopt a budget under section 5.6 of this chapter for budget years beginning after June 30, 2011, not later than the time required under section 5.6(b) of this chapter for budget years beginning after June 30, 2011.
(4) The governing body of a school corporation that is not described in subdivision (1) or (3), not later than November 1.
Except in a consolidated city and county and in a second class city, the public hearing required by section 3 of this chapter must be completed at least ten (10) days before the proper officers of the political subdivision meet to fix the budget, tax rate, and tax levy. In a consolidated city and county and in a second class city, that public
hearing, by any committee or by the entire fiscal body, may be held at
any time after introduction of the budget.
(b) Ten (10) or more taxpayers may object to a budget, tax rate, or
tax levy of a political subdivision fixed under subsection (a) by filing
an objection petition with the proper officers of the political
subdivision not more than seven (7) days after the hearing. The
objection petition must specifically identify the provisions of the
budget, tax rate, and tax levy to which the taxpayers object.
(c) If a petition is filed under subsection (b), the fiscal body of the
political subdivision shall adopt with its budget a finding concerning
the objections in the petition and any testimony presented at the
adoption hearing.
(d) This subsection does not apply to a school corporation. Each
year at least two (2) days before the first meeting of the county board
of tax adjustment held under IC 6-1.1-29-4, a political subdivision shall
file with the county auditor:
(1) a statement of the tax rate and levy fixed by the political
subdivision for the ensuing budget year;
(2) two (2) copies of the budget adopted by the political
subdivision for the ensuing budget year; and
(3) two (2) copies of any findings adopted under subsection (c).
Each year the county auditor shall present these items to the county
board of tax adjustment at the board's first meeting under
IC 6-1.1-29-4.
(e) In a consolidated city and county and in a second class city, the
clerk of the fiscal body shall, notwithstanding subsection (d), file the
adopted budget and tax ordinances with the county board of tax
adjustment within two (2) days after the ordinances are signed by the
executive, or within two (2) days after action is taken by the fiscal body
to override a veto of the ordinances, whichever is later.
(f) If a fiscal body does not fix the budget, tax rate, and tax levy of
the political subdivisions for the ensuing budget year as required under
this section, the most recent annual appropriations and annual tax levy
are continued for the ensuing budget year.
school corporation may elect to adopt a budget under this section that
applies from July 1 of the year through June 30 of the following year.
In the initial budget adopted by a school corporation under this section,
the first six (6) months of that initial budget must be consistent with the
last six (6) months of the budget adopted by the school corporation for
the calendar year in which the school corporation elects by resolution
to begin adopting budgets that correspond to the state fiscal year. A
corporation shall submit a copy of the resolution to the department of
local government finance and the department of education not more
than thirty (30) days after the date the governing body adopts the
resolution.
(b) Before February 1 of each year, the officers of the school
corporation shall meet to fix the budget for the school corporation for
the ensuing budget year, with notice given by the same officers.
However, if a resolution adopted under subsection (d) is in effect, the
officers shall meet to fix the budget for the ensuing budget year before
November 1.
(c) Each year, at least two (2) days before the first meeting of the
county board of tax adjustment held under IC 6-1.1-29-4, the school
corporation shall file with the county auditor:
(1) a statement of the tax rate and tax levy fixed by the school
corporation for the ensuing budget year;
(2) two (2) copies of the budget adopted by the school corporation
for the ensuing budget year; and
(3) any written notification from the department of local
government finance under section 16(i) of this chapter that
specifies a proposed revision, reduction, or increase in the budget
adopted by the school corporation for the ensuing budget year.
Each year the county auditor shall present these items to the county
board of tax adjustment at the board's first meeting under
IC 6-1.1-29-4.
(d) The governing body of the school corporation may adopt a
resolution to cease using a school year budget year and return to using
a calendar year budget year. A resolution adopted under this subsection
must be adopted after January 1 and before July 1. The school
corporation's initial calendar year budget year following the adoption
of a resolution under this subsection begins on January 1 of the year
following the year the resolution is adopted. The first six (6) months of
the initial calendar year budget for the school corporation must be
consistent with the last six (6) months of the final school year budget
fixed by the department of local government finance before the
adoption of a resolution under this subsection.
(e) A resolution adopted under subsection (d) may be rescinded by a subsequent resolution adopted by the governing body. If the governing body of the school corporation rescinds a resolution adopted under subsection (d) and returns to a school year budget year, the school corporation's initial school year budget year begins on July 1 following the adoption of the rescinding resolution and ends on June 30 of the following year. The first six (6) months of the initial school year budget for the school corporation must be consistent with the last six (6) months of the last calendar year budget fixed by the department of local government finance before the adoption of a rescinding resolution under this subsection.
(b) The ad valorem property tax levy limits imposed by section 3 of this chapter do not apply to ad valorem property taxes imposed by a civil taxing unit under IC 8-10-5-17. For purposes of computing the ad valorem property tax levy limit imposed on a civil taxing unit under section 3 of this chapter, the civil taxing unit's ad valorem property tax levy for a particular calendar year does not include that part of the levy imposed under IC 8-10-5-17.
(1) Permission to the civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter, if in the judgment of the department the increase is reasonably necessary due to increased costs of the civil taxing unit resulting from annexation, consolidation, or other extensions of governmental services by the civil taxing unit to additional geographic areas or persons. With respect to annexation, consolidation, or other extensions of governmental services in a calendar year, if those increased costs are incurred by the civil taxing unit in that calendar year and more than one (1) immediately succeeding calendar year, the unit may appeal under section 12 of this chapter for permission to increase its levy under this subdivision based on those increased costs in any of the following:
(A) The first calendar year in which those costs are incurred.
(B) One (1) or more of the immediately succeeding four (4) calendar years.
(2) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008. Permission to the civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter, if the local government tax control board finds that the civil taxing unit needs the increase to meet the civil taxing unit's share of the costs of operating a court established by statute enacted after December 31, 1973. Before recommending such an increase, the local government tax control board shall consider all other revenues available to the civil taxing unit that could be applied for that purpose. The maximum aggregate levy increases that the local government tax control board may recommend for a particular court equals the civil taxing unit's estimate of the unit's share of the costs of operating a court for the first full calendar year in which it is in existence. For purposes of this subdivision, costs of operating a court include:
(A) the cost of personal services (including fringe benefits);
(B) the cost of supplies; and
(C) any other cost directly related to the operation of the court.
(3) Permission to the civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter, if the department finds that the quotient determined under STEP SIX of the following formula is equal to or greater than one and two-hundredths (1.02):
STEP ONE: Determine the three (3) calendar years that most immediately precede the ensuing calendar year and in which a statewide general reassessment of real property or the initial annual adjustment of the assessed value of real property under IC 6-1.1-4-4.5 does not first become effective.
STEP TWO: Compute separately, for each of the calendar years determined in STEP ONE, the quotient (rounded to the nearest ten-thousandth (0.0001)) of the sum of the civil taxing unit's total assessed value of all taxable property and:
(i) for a particular calendar year before 2007, the total assessed value of property tax deductions in the unit under IC 6-1.1-12-41 or IC 6-1.1-12-42 in the particular calendar year; or
(ii) for a particular calendar year after 2006, the total assessed value of property tax deductions that applied in the
unit under IC 6-1.1-12-42 in 2006 plus for a particular
calendar year after 2009, the total assessed value of property
tax deductions that applied in the unit under
IC 6-1.1-12-37.5 in 2008;
divided by the sum determined under this STEP for the
calendar year immediately preceding the particular calendar
year.
STEP THREE: Divide the sum of the three (3) quotients
computed in STEP TWO by three (3).
STEP FOUR: Compute separately, for each of the calendar
years determined in STEP ONE, the quotient (rounded to the
nearest ten-thousandth (0.0001)) of the sum of the total
assessed value of all taxable property in all counties and:
(i) for a particular calendar year before 2007, the total
assessed value of property tax deductions in all counties
under IC 6-1.1-12-41 or IC 6-1.1-12-42 in the particular
calendar year; or
(ii) for a particular calendar year after 2006, the total
assessed value of property tax deductions that applied in all
counties under IC 6-1.1-12-42 in 2006 plus for a particular
calendar year after 2009, the total assessed value of property
tax deductions that applied in the unit under
IC 6-1.1-12-37.5 in 2008;
divided by the sum determined under this STEP for the
calendar year immediately preceding the particular calendar
year.
STEP FIVE: Divide the sum of the three (3) quotients
computed in STEP FOUR by three (3).
STEP SIX: Divide the STEP THREE amount by the STEP
FIVE amount.
The civil taxing unit may increase its levy by a percentage not
greater than the percentage by which the STEP THREE amount
exceeds the percentage by which the civil taxing unit may
increase its levy under section 3 of this chapter based on the
assessed value growth quotient determined under section 2 of this
chapter.
(4) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission to the civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of
the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter, if the
local government tax control board finds that the civil taxing unit
needs the increase to pay the costs of furnishing fire protection for
the civil taxing unit through a volunteer fire department. For
purposes of determining a township's need for an increased levy,
the local government tax control board shall not consider the
amount of money borrowed under IC 36-6-6-14 during the
immediately preceding calendar year. However, any increase in
the amount of the civil taxing unit's levy recommended by the
local government tax control board under this subdivision for the
ensuing calendar year may not exceed the lesser of:
(A) ten thousand dollars ($10,000); or
(B) twenty percent (20%) of:
(i) the amount authorized for operating expenses of a
volunteer fire department in the budget of the civil taxing
unit for the immediately preceding calendar year; plus
(ii) the amount of any additional appropriations authorized
during that calendar year for the civil taxing unit's use in
paying operating expenses of a volunteer fire department
under this chapter; minus
(iii) the amount of money borrowed under IC 36-6-6-14
during that calendar year for the civil taxing unit's use in
paying operating expenses of a volunteer fire department.
(5) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission to a civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of
the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter in order
to raise revenues for pension payments and contributions the civil
taxing unit is required to make under IC 36-8. The maximum
increase in a civil taxing unit's levy that may be recommended
under this subdivision for an ensuing calendar year equals the
amount, if any, by which the pension payments and contributions
the civil taxing unit is required to make under IC 36-8 during the
ensuing calendar year exceeds the product of one and one-tenth
(1.1) multiplied by the pension payments and contributions made
by the civil taxing unit under IC 36-8 during the calendar year that
immediately precedes the ensuing calendar year. For purposes of
this subdivision, "pension payments and contributions made by a
civil taxing unit" does not include that part of the payments or
contributions that are funded by distributions made to a civil
taxing unit by the state.
(6) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission to increase its levy in excess of the limitations
established under section 3 of this chapter if the local government
tax control board finds that:
(A) the township's township assistance ad valorem property
tax rate is less than one and sixty-seven hundredths cents
($0.0167) per one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed
valuation; and
(B) the township needs the increase to meet the costs of
providing township assistance under IC 12-20 and IC 12-30-4.
The maximum increase that the board may recommend for a
township is the levy that would result from an increase in the
township's township assistance ad valorem property tax rate of
one and sixty-seven hundredths cents ($0.0167) per one hundred
dollars ($100) of assessed valuation minus the township's ad
valorem property tax rate per one hundred dollars ($100) of
assessed valuation before the increase.
(7) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission to a civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of
the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter if:
(A) the increase has been approved by the legislative body of
the municipality with the largest population where the civil
taxing unit provides public transportation services; and
(B) the local government tax control board finds that the civil
taxing unit needs the increase to provide adequate public
transportation services.
The local government tax control board shall consider tax rates
and levies in civil taxing units of comparable population, and the
effect (if any) of a loss of federal or other funds to the civil taxing
unit that might have been used for public transportation purposes.
However, the increase that the board may recommend under this
subdivision for a civil taxing unit may not exceed the revenue that
would be raised by the civil taxing unit based on a property tax
rate of one cent ($0.01) per one hundred dollars ($100) of
assessed valuation.
(8) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission to a civil taxing unit to increase the unit's levy in
excess of the limitations established under section 3 of this
chapter if the local government tax control board finds that:
(A) the civil taxing unit is:
(i) a county having a population of more than one hundred
forty-eight seventy thousand (148,000) (170,000) but less
than one hundred seventy seventy-five thousand (170,000);
(175,000);
(ii) a city having a population of more than fifty-five
sixty-five thousand (55,000) (65,000) but less than fifty-nine
seventy thousand (59,000); (70,000);
(iii) a city having a population of more than twenty-eight
twenty-nine thousand seven five hundred (28,700) (29,500)
but less than twenty-nine thousand (29,000); six hundred
(29,600);
(iv) a city having a population of more than fifteen thirteen
thousand four hundred (15,400) fifty (13,450) but less than
sixteen thirteen thousand six five hundred (16,600);
(13,500); or
(v) a city having a population of more than seven eight
thousand (7,000) seven hundred (8,700) but less than seven
nine thousand three hundred (7,300); (9,000); and
(B) the increase is necessary to provide funding to undertake
removal (as defined in IC 13-11-2-187) and remedial action
(as defined in IC 13-11-2-185) relating to hazardous
substances (as defined in IC 13-11-2-98) in solid waste
disposal facilities or industrial sites in the civil taxing unit that
have become a menace to the public health and welfare.
The maximum increase that the local government tax control
board may recommend for such a civil taxing unit is the levy that
would result from a property tax rate of six and sixty-seven
hundredths cents ($0.0667) for each one hundred dollars ($100)
of assessed valuation. For purposes of computing the ad valorem
property tax levy limit imposed on a civil taxing unit under
section 3 of this chapter, the civil taxing unit's ad valorem
property tax levy for a particular year does not include that part of
the levy imposed under this subdivision. In addition, a property
tax increase permitted under this subdivision may be imposed for
only two (2) calendar years.
(9) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission for a county:
(A) having a population of more than eighty thousand (80,000)
but less than ninety thousand (90,000) to increase the county's
levy in excess of the limitations established under section 3 of
this chapter, if the local government tax control board finds
that the county needs the increase to meet the county's share of
the costs of operating a jail or juvenile detention center,
including expansion of the facility, if the jail or juvenile
detention center is opened after December 31, 1991;
(B) that operates a county jail or juvenile detention center that
is subject to an order that:
(i) was issued by a federal district court; and
(ii) has not been terminated;
(C) that operates a county jail that fails to meet:
(i) American Correctional Association Jail Construction
Standards; and
(ii) Indiana jail operation standards adopted by the
department of correction; or
(D) that operates a juvenile detention center that fails to meet
standards equivalent to the standards described in clause (C)
for the operation of juvenile detention centers.
Before recommending an increase, the local government tax
control board shall consider all other revenues available to the
county that could be applied for that purpose. An appeal for
operating funds for a jail or a juvenile detention center shall be
considered individually, if a jail and juvenile detention center are
both opened in one (1) county. The maximum aggregate levy
increases that the local government tax control board may
recommend for a county equals the county's share of the costs of
operating the jail or a juvenile detention center for the first full
calendar year in which the jail or juvenile detention center is in
operation.
(10) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission for a township to increase its levy in excess of the
limitations established under section 3 of this chapter, if the local
government tax control board finds that the township needs the
increase so that the property tax rate to pay the costs of furnishing
fire protection for a township, or a portion of a township, enables
the township to pay a fair and reasonable amount under a contract
with the municipality that is furnishing the fire protection.
However, for the first time an appeal is granted the resulting rate
increase may not exceed fifty percent (50%) of the difference
between the rate imposed for fire protection within the
municipality that is providing the fire protection to the township
and the township's rate. A township is required to appeal a second
time for an increase under this subdivision if the township wants
to further increase its rate. However, a township's rate may be
increased to equal but may not exceed the rate that is used by the
municipality. More than one (1) township served by the same
municipality may use this appeal.
(11) A levy increase may not be granted under this subdivision for
property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission for a township to increase its levy in excess of the
limitations established under section 3 of this chapter, if the local
government tax control board finds that the township has been
required, for the three (3) consecutive years preceding the year for
which the appeal under this subdivision is to become effective, to
borrow funds under IC 36-6-6-14 to furnish fire protection for the
township or a part of the township. However, the maximum
increase in a township's levy that may be allowed under this
subdivision is the least of the amounts borrowed under
IC 36-6-6-14 during the preceding three (3) calendar years. A
township may elect to phase in an approved increase in its levy
under this subdivision over a period not to exceed three (3) years.
A particular township may appeal to increase its levy under this
section not more frequently than every fourth calendar year.
(12) Permission to a city having a population of more than
twenty-nine thirty-one thousand (29,000) five hundred (31,500)
but less than thirty-one thousand (31,000) seven hundred
twenty-five (31,725) to increase its levy in excess of the
limitations established under section 3 of this chapter if:
(A) an appeal was granted to the city under this section to
reallocate property tax replacement credits under IC 6-3.5-1.1
in 1998, 1999, and 2000; and
(B) the increase has been approved by the legislative body of
the city, and the legislative body of the city has by resolution
determined that the increase is necessary to pay normal
operating expenses.
The maximum amount of the increase is equal to the amount of
property tax replacement credits under IC 6-3.5-1.1 that the city
petitioned under this section to have reallocated in 2001 for a
purpose other than property tax relief.
(13) A levy increase may be granted under this subdivision only
for property taxes first due and payable after December 31, 2008.
Permission to a civil taxing unit to increase its levy in excess of
the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter if the
civil taxing unit cannot carry out its governmental functions for
an ensuing calendar year under the levy limitations imposed by
section 3 of this chapter due to a natural disaster, an accident, or
another unanticipated emergency.
(14) Permission to Jefferson County to increase its levy in excess
of the limitations established under section 3 of this chapter if the
department finds that the county experienced a property tax
revenue shortfall that resulted from an erroneous estimate of the
effect of the supplemental deduction under IC 6-1.1-12-37.5 on
the county's assessed valuation. An appeal for a levy increase
under this subdivision may not be denied because of the amount
of cash balances in county funds. The maximum increase in the
county's levy that may be approved under this subdivision is three
hundred thousand dollars ($300,000).
(b) The department of local government finance shall increase the
maximum permissible ad valorem property tax levy under section 3 of
this chapter for the city of Goshen for 2012 and thereafter by an
amount equal to the greater of zero (0) or the result of:
(1) the city's total pension costs in 2009 for the 1925 police
pension fund (IC 36-8-6) and the 1937 firefighters' pension fund
(IC 36-8-7); minus
(2) the sum of:
(A) the total amount of state funds received in 2009 by the city
and used to pay benefits to members of the 1925 police
pension fund (IC 36-8-6) or the 1937 firefighters' pension fund
(IC 36-8-7); plus
(B) any previous permanent increases to the city's levy that
were authorized to account for the transfer to the state of the
responsibility to pay benefits to members of the 1925 police
pension fund (IC 36-8-6) and the 1937 firefighters' pension
fund (IC 36-8-7).
(1) twenty-five thousand dollars ($25,000); or
(2) twenty percent (20%) of the sum of:
(A) the amount authorized for the cost of furnishing fire protection in the town's budget for the immediately preceding calendar year; plus
(B) the amount of any additional appropriations authorized under IC 6-1.1-18-5 during that calendar year for the town's use in paying the costs of furnishing fire protection.
(1) A city having a population of more than
(2) The sanitary district of a city described in subdivision (1).
(3) The library district of a city described in subdivision (1).
(4) The school corporation located in a city described in subdivision (1).
(1) delinquent taxes and special assessments due before the date the list on which the property appears was certified under section 1 of this chapter; and
(2) penalties due on the delinquency, interest, and costs directly attributable to the tax sale;
have been paid in full.
(b) A county treasurer may accept partial payments of delinquent property taxes, assessments, penalties, interest, or costs under subsection (a) after the list of real property is certified under section 1 of this chapter. However a partial payment does not remove a tract or an item from the list certified under section 1 of this chapter unless the taxpayer complies with subsection (a) or (c) before the date of the tax
sale.
(c) The county auditor in a county having a population of more than
four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand
(700,000) may remove a tract or an item of real property from the list
certified under section 1 of this chapter before the tax sale if the county
treasurer and the taxpayer agree to a mutually satisfactory arrangement
for the payment of the delinquent taxes.
(d) The county treasurer may remove the tract or item from the list
certified under section 1 of this chapter if the arrangement described in
subsection (c):
(1) is in writing;
(2) is signed by the taxpayer; and
(3) requires the taxpayer to pay the delinquent taxes in full within
one (1) year of the date the agreement is signed.
(e) If the taxpayer fails to make a payment under the arrangement
described in subsection (c), the county auditor shall immediately place
the tract or item of real property on the list of real property eligible for
sale at a tax sale.
(f) If the tract or item of real property subject to a payment
arrangement is within the jurisdiction of a:
(1) city having a population of more than ninety eighty thousand
(90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five eighty thousand
(105,000); four hundred (80,400);
(2) city having a population of more than thirty-two twenty-nine
thousand (32,000) six hundred (29,600) but less than thirty-two
twenty-nine thousand eight nine hundred (32,800); (29,900); or
(3) city having a population of more than seventy-five eighty
thousand (75,000) five hundred (80,500) but less than ninety one
hundred thousand (90,000); (100,000);
the county auditor shall notify the mayor of the city of the arrangement.
(b) As used in this section, "fiscal year" means a twelve (12) month period beginning July 1 and ending June 30.
(c) The county council
(d) Notwithstanding section 2 of this chapter, if the county council adopts an ordinance under subsection (c), the county council may impose the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of one and one-tenth percent (1.1%) on adjusted gross income for fiscal years beginning before July 1, 2011. For fiscal years beginning after June 30, 2011, the rate is reduced to one percent (1%). If the county council imposes the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of one and one-tenth percent (1.1%), the county council may decrease the rate or rescind the tax in the manner provided under this chapter.
(e) If
(1) shall be paid to the county treasurer;
(2) may be used only to pay the costs of operating a jail and juvenile detention center opened after July 1, 1998; and
(3) may not be considered by the department of local government finance in determining the county's maximum permissible property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5.
(b) The county council may, by ordinance, determine that additional county adjusted gross income tax revenue is needed in the county to:
(1) finance, construct, acquire, improve, renovate, or equip the county jail and related buildings and parking facilities, including costs related to the demolition of existing buildings and the acquisition of land; and
(2) repay bonds issued, or leases entered into, for constructing, acquiring, improving, renovating, and equipping the county jail and related buildings and parking facilities, including costs related to the demolition of existing buildings and the acquisition of land.
(c) In addition to the rates permitted by section 2 of this chapter, the county council may impose the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of:
(1) fifteen-hundredths percent (0.15%);
(2) two-tenths percent (0.2%); or
(3) twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%);
on the adjusted gross income of county taxpayers if the county council
makes the finding and determination set forth in subsection (b). The tax
imposed under this section may be imposed only until the later of the
date on which the financing on, acquisition, improvement, renovation,
and equipping described in subsection (b) is completed or the date on
which the last of any bonds issued or leases entered into to finance the
construction, acquisition, improvement, renovation, and equipping
described in subsection (b) are fully paid. The term of the bonds issued
(including any refunding bonds) or a lease entered into under
subsection (b)(2) may not exceed twenty (20) years.
(d) If the county council makes a determination under subsection
(b), the county council may adopt a tax rate under subsection (c). The
tax rate may not be imposed at a rate greater than is necessary to pay
the costs of financing, acquiring, improving, renovating, and equipping
the county jail and related buildings and parking facilities, including
costs related to the demolition of existing buildings and the acquisition
of land.
(e) The county treasurer shall establish a county jail revenue fund
to be used only for purposes described in this section. County adjusted
gross income tax revenues derived from the tax rate imposed under this
section shall be deposited in the county jail revenue fund before
making a certified distribution under section 11 of this chapter.
(f) County adjusted gross income tax revenues derived from the tax
rate imposed under this section:
(1) may only be used for the purposes described in this section;
(2) may not be considered by the department of local government
finance in determining the county's maximum permissible
property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5; and
(3) may be pledged to the repayment of bonds issued, or leases
entered into, for purposes described in subsection (b).
(g) A Wayne County described in subsection (a) possesses unique
economic development challenges due to underemployment in relation
to similarly situated counties. Maintaining low property tax rates is
essential to economic development and the use of county adjusted
gross income tax revenues as provided in this chapter to pay any bonds
issued or leases entered into to finance the construction, acquisition,
improvement, renovation, and equipping described under subsection
(b), rather than use of property taxes, promotes that purpose.
(h) Notwithstanding any other law, funds accumulated from the
county adjusted gross income tax imposed under this section after:
(1) the redemption of bonds issued; or
(2) the final payment of lease rentals due under a lease entered
into under this section;
shall be transferred to the county highway fund to be used for construction, resurfacing, restoration, and rehabilitation of county highways, roads, and bridges.
(1)
(2)
(b) The county council may, by ordinance, determine that additional county adjusted gross income tax revenue is needed in the county to:
(1) finance, construct, acquire, improve, renovate, or equip:
(A) jail facilities;
(B) juvenile court, detention, and probation facilities;
(C) other criminal justice facilities; and
(D) related buildings and parking facilities;
located in the county, including costs related to the demolition of existing buildings and the acquisition of land; and
(2) repay bonds issued or leases entered into for the purposes described in subdivision (1).
(c) The county council may, by ordinance, determine that additional county adjusted gross income tax revenue is needed in the county to operate or maintain:
(1) jail facilities;
(2) juvenile court, detention, and probation facilities;
(3) other criminal justice facilities; and
(4) related buildings and parking facilities;
located in the county. A county council of a county
(d) In addition to the rates permitted by section 2 of this chapter, the county council may impose the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of:
(1) fifteen-hundredths percent (0.15%);
(2) two-tenths percent (0.2%); or
(3) twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%);
on the adjusted gross income of county taxpayers if the county council makes a finding and determination set forth in subsection (b) or (c).
The tax rate may not be imposed at a rate greater than is necessary to
carry out the purposes described in subsections (b) and (c), as
applicable.
(e) This subsection applies only to a Elkhart County. described in
subsection (a)(1). If the county council imposes the tax under this
section to pay for the purposes described in both subsections (b) and
(c), when:
(1) the financing, construction, acquisition, improvement,
renovation, and equipping described in subsection (b) are
completed; and
(2) all bonds issued (including any refunding bonds) or leases
entered into to finance the construction, acquisition,
improvement, renovation, and equipping described in subsection
(b) are fully paid;
the county council shall, subject to subsection (d), establish a tax rate
under this section by ordinance such that the revenue from the tax does
not exceed the costs of operating and maintaining the jail facilities
referred to in subsection (b)(1)(A).
(f) The tax imposed under this section may be imposed only until
the last of the following dates:
(1) The date on which the financing, construction, acquisition,
improvement, renovation, and equipping described in subsection
(b) are completed.
(2) The date on which the last of any bonds issued (including any
refunding bonds) or leases entered into to finance the
construction, acquisition, improvement, renovation, and
equipping described in subsection (b) are fully paid.
(3) If the county imposing the tax under this section is a Elkhart
County, described in subsection (a)(1), the date on which an
ordinance adopted under subsection (c) is rescinded.
(g) The term of the bonds issued (including any refunding bonds) or
a lease entered into under subsection (b)(2) may not exceed twenty (20)
years.
(h) The county treasurer shall establish a criminal justice facilities
revenue fund to be used only for purposes described in this section.
County adjusted gross income tax revenues derived from the tax rate
imposed under this section shall be deposited in the criminal justice
facilities revenue fund before making a certified distribution under
section 11 of this chapter.
(i) County adjusted gross income tax revenues derived from the tax
rate imposed under this section:
(1) may be used only for the purposes described in this section;
(2) may not be considered by the department of local government finance in determining the county's maximum permissible property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5; and
(3) may be pledged to the repayment of bonds issued or leases entered into for any or all the purposes described in subsection (b).
(j) Notwithstanding any other law, money remaining in the criminal justice facilities revenue fund established under subsection (h) after the tax imposed by this section is terminated under subsection (f) shall be transferred to the county highway fund to be used for construction, resurfacing, restoration, and rehabilitation of county highways, roads, and bridges.
(b) The county council may, by ordinance, determine that additional county adjusted gross income tax revenue is needed in the county to:
(1) finance, construct, acquire, improve, renovate, remodel, or equip the county jail and related buildings and parking facilities, including costs related to the demolition of existing buildings, the acquisition of land, and any other reasonably related costs; and
(2) repay bonds issued or leases entered into for constructing, acquiring, improving, renovating, remodeling, and equipping the county jail and related buildings and parking facilities, including costs related to the demolition of existing buildings, the acquisition of land, and any other reasonably related costs.
(c) In addition to the rates permitted by section 2 of this chapter, the county council may impose the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of:
(1) fifteen-hundredths percent (0.15%);
(2) two-tenths percent (0.2%); or
(3) twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%);
on the adjusted gross income of county taxpayers if the county council makes the finding and determination set forth in subsection (b). The tax imposed under this section may be imposed only until the later of the date on which the financing on, acquisition, improvement, renovation, remodeling, and equipping described in subsection (b) are completed or the date on which the last of any bonds issued or leases entered into to finance the construction, acquisition, improvement, renovation, remodeling, and equipping described in subsection (b) are fully paid. The term of the bonds issued (including any refunding bonds) or a
lease entered into under subsection (b)(2) may not exceed twenty-five
(25) years.
(d) If the county council makes a determination under subsection
(b), the county council may adopt a tax rate under subsection (c). The
tax rate may not be imposed at a rate greater than is necessary to pay
the costs of financing, acquiring, improving, renovating, remodeling,
and equipping the county jail and related buildings and parking
facilities, including costs related to the demolition of existing
buildings, the acquisition of land, and any other reasonably related
costs.
(e) The county treasurer shall establish a county jail revenue fund
to be used only for purposes described in this section. County adjusted
gross income tax revenues derived from the tax rate imposed under this
section shall be deposited in the county jail revenue fund before
making a certified distribution under section 11 of this chapter.
(f) County adjusted gross income tax revenues derived from the tax
rate imposed under this section:
(1) may be used only for the purposes described in this section;
(2) may not be considered by the department of local government
finance in determining the county's maximum permissible
property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5; and
(3) may be pledged to the repayment of bonds issued or leases
entered into for purposes described in subsection (b).
(g) A Daviess County described in subsection (a) possesses unique
governmental and economic development challenges due to:
(1) underemployment in relation to similarly situated counties and
the loss of a major manufacturing business;
(2) an increase in property taxes for taxable years after December
31, 2000, for the construction of a new elementary school; and
(3) overcrowding of the county jail, the costs associated with
housing the county's inmates outside the county, and the potential
unavailability of additional housing for inmates outside the
county.
The use of county adjusted gross income tax revenues as provided in
this chapter is necessary for the county to provide adequate jail
capacity in the county and to maintain low property tax rates essential
to economic development. The use of county adjusted gross income tax
revenues as provided in this chapter to pay any bonds issued or leases
entered into to finance the construction, acquisition, improvement,
renovation, remodeling, and equipping described in subsection (b),
rather than the use of property taxes, promotes those purposes.
(h) Notwithstanding any other law, funds accumulated from the
county adjusted gross income tax imposed under this section after:
(1) the redemption of bonds issued; or
(2) the final payment of lease rentals due under a lease entered
into under this section;
shall be transferred to the county highway fund to be used for
construction, resurfacing, restoration, and rehabilitation of county
highways, roads, and bridges.
"The ________ County Council decreases the county adjusted gross income tax rate imposed upon the resident county taxpayers of the county from _____ percent (___%) to _____ percent (___%).".
(b) A county council may not decrease the county adjusted gross income tax rate if the county or any commission, board, department, or authority that is authorized by statute to pledge the county adjusted gross income tax has pledged the county adjusted gross income tax for any purpose permitted by IC 5-1-14 or any other statute.
(c) The auditor of a county shall record all votes taken on ordinances presented for a vote under the authority of this section and immediately send a certified copy of the results to the department by certified mail.
(d) Notwithstanding IC 6-3.5-7, and except as provided in subsection (e), a county council that decreases the county adjusted gross income tax rate in a year may not in the same year adopt or increase the county economic development income tax under IC 6-3.5-7.
(e) This subsection applies only to
decreasing the rate of the county adjusted gross income tax.
(b) The county council
(c) Notwithstanding section 2 of this chapter, if the county council adopts an ordinance under subsection (b), the county council may impose the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of one and three-tenths percent (1.3%) on adjusted gross income. However, a county may impose the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of one and three-tenths percent (1.3%) for only eight (8) years. After the county has imposed the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of one and three-tenths percent (1.3%) for eight (8) years, the rate is reduced to one percent (1%). If the county council imposes the county adjusted gross income tax at a rate of one and three-tenths percent (1.3%), the county council may decrease the rate or rescind the tax in the manner provided under this chapter.
(d) If
(1) shall be paid to the county treasurer;
(2) may be used only to pay the costs of operating and maintaining a jail and justice center; and
(3) may not be considered by the department of local government finance under any provision of IC 6-1.1-18.5, including the determination of the county's maximum permissible property tax levy.
(b) The county council may, by ordinance, determine that additional county adjusted gross income tax revenue is needed in the county to:
(1) finance, construct, acquire, improve, renovate, or equip the county courthouse; and
(2) repay bonds issued, or leases entered into, for constructing,
acquiring, improving, renovating, and equipping the county
courthouse.
(c) In addition to the rates permitted under section 2 of this chapter,
the county council may impose the county adjusted gross income tax
at a rate of twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%) on the adjusted
gross income of county taxpayers if the county council makes the
finding and determination set forth in subsection (b). The tax imposed
under this section may be imposed only until the later of the date on
which the financing on, acquisition, improvement, renovation, and
equipping described in subsection (b) is completed or the date on
which the last of any bonds issued or leases entered into to finance the
construction, acquisition, improvement, renovation, and equipping
described in subsection (b) are fully paid. The term of the bonds issued
(including any refunding bonds) or a lease entered into under
subsection (b)(2) may not exceed twenty-two (22) years.
(d) If the county council makes a determination under subsection
(b), the county council may adopt a tax rate under subsection (c). The
tax rate may not be imposed for a time greater than is necessary to pay
the costs of financing, constructing, acquiring, renovating, and
equipping the county courthouse.
(e) The county treasurer shall establish a county courthouse revenue
fund to be used only for purposes described in this section. County
adjusted gross income tax revenues derived from the tax rate imposed
under this section shall be deposited in the county courthouse revenue
fund before a certified distribution is made under section 11 of this
chapter.
(f) County adjusted gross income tax revenues derived from the tax
rate imposed under this section:
(1) may only be used for the purposes described in this section;
(2) may not be considered by the department of local government
finance in determining the county's maximum permissible
property tax levy under IC 6-1.1-18.5; and
(3) may be pledged to the repayment of bonds issued or leases
entered into for purposes described in subsection (b).
(g) A Union County described in subsection (a) possesses unique
economic development challenges due to:
(1) the county's heavy agricultural base;
(2) the presence of a large amount of state owned property in the
county that is exempt from property taxation; and
(3) recent obligations of the school corporation in the county that
have already increased property taxes in the county and imposed
additional property tax burdens on the county's agricultural base.
Maintaining low property tax rates is essential to economic development. The use of county adjusted gross income tax revenues as provided in this chapter to pay any bonds issued or leases entered into to finance the construction, acquisition, improvement, renovation, and equipping described in subsection (b), rather than the use of property taxes, promotes that purpose.
(h) Notwithstanding any other law, funds accumulated from the county adjusted gross income tax imposed under this section after:
(1) the redemption of the bonds issued; or
(2) the final payment of lease rentals due under a lease entered into under this section;
shall be transferred to the county highway fund to be used for construction, resurfacing, restoration, and rehabilitation of county highways, roads, and bridges.
(b) This subsection applies to
(1) One-fourth (1/4) on October 1 of the calendar year in which the ordinance was adopted.
(2) One-fourth (1/4) on January 1 of the calendar year following the year in which the ordinance was adopted.
(3) One-fourth (1/4) on May 1 of the calendar year following the year in which the ordinance was adopted.
(4) One-fourth (1/4) on November 1 of the calendar year following the year in which the ordinance was adopted.
Notwithstanding section 11 of this chapter, the part of the certified distribution received under subdivision (1) that would otherwise be allocated to a civil taxing unit or school corporation as property tax
replacement credits under section 11 of this chapter shall be set aside
and treated for the calendar year when received by the civil taxing unit
or school corporation as a levy excess subject to IC 6-1.1-18.5-17 or
IC 20-44-3. Certified distributions made to the county treasurer for
calendar years following the eighteen (18) month period described in
this subsection shall be made as provided in subsection (a).
(c) Except for:
(1) revenue that must be used to pay the costs of:
(A) financing, constructing, acquiring, improving, renovating,
equipping, operating, or maintaining facilities and buildings;
(B) debt service on bonds; or
(C) lease rentals;
under section 2.3 of this chapter;
(2) revenue that must be used to pay the costs of operating a jail
and juvenile detention center under section 2.5 of this chapter;
(3) revenue that must be used to pay the costs of:
(A) financing, constructing, acquiring, improving, renovating,
equipping, operating, or maintaining facilities and buildings;
(B) debt service on bonds; or
(C) lease rentals;
under section 2.8 of this chapter;
(4) revenue that must be used to pay the costs of construction,
improvement, renovation, or remodeling of a jail and related
buildings and parking structures under section 2.7, 2.9, or 3.3 of
this chapter;
(5) revenue that must be used to pay the costs of operating and
maintaining a jail and justice center under section 3.5(d) of this
chapter;
(6) revenue that must be used to pay the costs of constructing,
acquiring, improving, renovating, or equipping a county
courthouse under section 3.6 of this chapter;
(7) revenue under section 2.6 of this chapter; or
(8) revenue attributable to a tax rate under section 24, 25, or 26 of
this chapter;
distributions made to a county treasurer under subsections (a) and (b)
shall be treated as though they were property taxes that were due and
payable during that same calendar year. Except as provided by
subsection (b) and sections 24, 25, and 26 of this chapter, the certified
distribution shall be distributed and used by the taxing units and school
corporations as provided in sections 11 through 15 of this chapter.
(d) All distributions from an account established under section 8 of
this chapter shall be made by warrants issued by the auditor of the state
to the treasurer of the state ordering the appropriate payments.
(b) In the case of a county taxpayer who is not a resident of a county that has imposed the county economic development income tax, the term "adjusted gross income" includes only adjusted gross income derived from the taxpayer's principal place of business or employment.
(c) In the case of a county taxpayer who is a resident of
(1) earned in a county that is:
(A) located in another state; and
(B) adjacent to the county in which the taxpayer resides; and
(2) subject to an income tax imposed by a county, city, town, or other local governmental entity in the other state.
(1) the county income tax council (as defined in IC 6-3.5-6-1) if the county option income tax is in effect on March 31 of the year the county economic development income tax is imposed;
(2) the county council if the county adjusted gross income tax is in effect on March 31 of the year the county economic development tax is imposed; or
(3) the county income tax council or the county council, whichever acts first, for a county not covered by subdivision (1) or (2).
To impose the county economic development income tax, a county income tax council shall use the procedures set forth in IC 6-3.5-6 concerning the imposition of the county option income tax.
(b) Except as provided in subsections (c), (g), (k), (p), and (r) and section 28 of this chapter, the county economic development income tax may be imposed at a rate of:
(1) one-tenth percent (0.1%);
(2) two-tenths percent (0.2%);
(3) twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%);
(4) three-tenths percent (0.3%);
(5) thirty-five hundredths percent (0.35%);
(6) four-tenths percent (0.4%);
(7) forty-five hundredths percent (0.45%); or
(8) five-tenths percent (0.5%);
on the adjusted gross income of county taxpayers.
(c) Except as provided in subsection (h), (i), (j), (k), (l), (m), (n), (o), (p), (s), (v), (w), (x), or (y), the county economic development income tax rate plus the county adjusted gross income tax rate, if any, that are in effect on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and twenty-five hundredths percent (1.25%). Except as provided in subsection (g), (p), (r), (t), (u), (w), (x), or (y), the county economic development tax rate plus the county option income tax rate, if any, that are in effect on January 1 of a year may not exceed one percent (1%).
(d) To impose, increase, decrease, or rescind the county economic development income tax, the appropriate body must adopt an ordinance.
(e) The ordinance to impose the tax must substantially state the following:
"The ________ County _________ imposes the county economic development income tax on the county taxpayers of _________ County. The county economic development income tax is imposed at a rate of _________ percent (____%) on the county taxpayers of the county.".
(f) The auditor of a county shall record all votes taken on ordinances presented for a vote under the authority of this chapter and shall, not more than ten (10) days after the vote, send a certified copy of the results to the commissioner of the department by certified mail.
(g) This subsection applies to
(1) county economic development income tax may be imposed at a rate of:
(A) fifteen-hundredths percent (0.15%);
(B) two-tenths percent (0.2%); or
(C) twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%); and
(2) county economic development income tax rate plus the county option income tax rate that are in effect on January 1 of a year may equal up to one and twenty-five hundredths percent (1.25%);
if the county income tax council makes a determination to impose rates under this subsection and section 22 of this chapter.
(h) For
(i) For
(j) For
(k) This subsection applies to
provided in subsection (p), in addition to the rates permitted under
subsection (b):
(1) the county economic development income tax may be imposed
at a rate of twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%); and
(2) the sum of the county economic development income tax rate
and the county adjusted gross income tax rate that are in effect on
January 1 of a year may not exceed one and five-tenths percent
(1.5%);
if the county council makes a determination to impose rates under this
subsection and section 22.5 of this chapter.
(l) For a Daviess County, having a population of more than
twenty-nine thousand (29,000) but less than thirty thousand (30,000),
except as provided in subsection (p), the county economic development
income tax rate plus the county adjusted gross income tax rate that are
in effect on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and five-tenths
percent (1.5%).
(m) For:
(1) a Elkhart County; having a population of more than one
hundred eighty-two thousand seven hundred ninety (182,790) but
less than two hundred thousand (200,000); or
(2) a Marshall County; having a population of more than
forty-five thousand (45,000) but less than forty-five thousand nine
hundred (45,900);
except as provided in subsection (p), the county economic development
income tax rate plus the county adjusted gross income tax rate that are
in effect on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and five-tenths
percent (1.5%).
(n) For a Union County, having a population of more than six
thousand (6,000) but less than eight thousand (8,000), except as
provided in subsection (p), the county economic development income
tax rate plus the county adjusted gross income tax rate that are in effect
on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and five-tenths percent
(1.5%).
(o) This subsection applies to a Knox County. having a population
of more than thirty-nine thousand (39,000) but less than thirty-nine
thousand six hundred (39,600). Except as provided in subsection (p),
in addition to the rates permitted under subsection (b):
(1) the county economic development income tax may be imposed
at a rate of twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%); and
(2) the sum of the county economic development income tax rate
and:
(A) the county adjusted gross income tax rate that are in effect
on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and five-tenths
percent (1.5%); or
(B) the county option income tax rate that are in effect on
January 1 of a year may not exceed one and twenty-five
hundredths percent (1.25%);
if the county council makes a determination to impose rates under this
subsection and section 24 of this chapter.
(p) In addition:
(1) the county economic development income tax may be imposed
at a rate that exceeds by not more than twenty-five hundredths
percent (0.25%) the maximum rate that would otherwise apply
under this section; and
(2) the:
(A) county economic development income tax; and
(B) county option income tax or county adjusted gross income
tax;
may be imposed at combined rates that exceed by not more than
twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%) the maximum combined
rates that would otherwise apply under this section.
However, the additional rate imposed under this subsection may not
exceed the amount necessary to mitigate the increased ad valorem
property taxes on homesteads (as defined in IC 6-1.1-20.9-1 (repealed)
before January 1, 2009, or IC 6-1.1-12-37 after December 31, 2008) or
residential property (as defined in section 26 of this chapter), as
appropriate under the ordinance adopted by the adopting body in the
county, resulting from the deduction of the assessed value of inventory
in the county under IC 6-1.1-12-41 or IC 6-1.1-12-42 or from the
exclusion in 2008 of inventory from the definition of personal property
in IC 6-1.1-1-11.
(q) If the county economic development income tax is imposed as
authorized under subsection (p) at a rate that exceeds the maximum
rate that would otherwise apply under this section, the certified
distribution must be used for the purpose provided in section 25(e) or
26 of this chapter to the extent that the certified distribution results
from the difference between:
(1) the actual county economic development tax rate; and
(2) the maximum rate that would otherwise apply under this
section.
(r) This subsection applies only to a county described in section 27
of this chapter. Except as provided in subsection (p), in addition to the
rates permitted by subsection (b), the:
(1) county economic development income tax may be imposed at
a rate of twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%); and
(2) county economic development income tax rate plus the county
option income tax rate that are in effect on January 1 of a year
may equal up to one and twenty-five hundredths percent (1.25%);
if the county council makes a determination to impose rates under this
subsection and section 27 of this chapter.
(s) Except as provided in subsection (p), the county economic
development income tax rate plus the county adjusted gross income tax
rate that are in effect on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and
five-tenths percent (1.5%) if the county has imposed the county
adjusted gross income tax under IC 6-3.5-1.1-3.3.
(t) This subsection applies to Howard County. Except as provided
in subsection (p), the sum of the county economic development income
tax rate and the county option income tax rate that are in effect on
January 1 of a year may not exceed one and twenty-five hundredths
percent (1.25%).
(u) This subsection applies to Scott County. Except as provided in
subsection (p), the sum of the county economic development income
tax rate and the county option income tax rate that are in effect on
January 1 of a year may not exceed one and twenty-five hundredths
percent (1.25%).
(v) This subsection applies to Jasper County. Except as provided in
subsection (p), the sum of the county economic development income
tax rate and the county adjusted gross income tax rate that are in effect
on January 1 of a year may not exceed one and five-tenths percent
(1.5%).
(w) An additional county economic development income tax rate
imposed under section 28 of this chapter may not be considered in
calculating any limit under this section on the sum of:
(1) the county economic development income tax rate plus the
county adjusted gross income tax rate; or
(2) the county economic development tax rate plus the county
option income tax rate.
(x) The income tax rate limits imposed by subsection (c) or (y) or
any other provision of this chapter do not apply to:
(1) a county adjusted gross income tax rate imposed under
IC 6-3.5-1.1-24, IC 6-3.5-1.1-25, or IC 6-3.5-1.1-26; or
(2) a county option income tax rate imposed under IC 6-3.5-6-30,
IC 6-3.5-6-31, or IC 6-3.5-6-32.
For purposes of computing the maximum combined income tax rate
under subsection (c) or (y) or any other provision of this chapter that
may be imposed in a county under IC 6-3.5-1.1, IC 6-3.5-6, and this
chapter, a county's county adjusted gross income tax rate or county
option income tax rate for a particular year does not include the county
adjusted gross income tax rate imposed under IC 6-3.5-1.1-24,
IC 6-3.5-1.1-25, or IC 6-3.5-1.1-26 or the county option income tax rate
imposed under IC 6-3.5-6-30, IC 6-3.5-6-31, or IC 6-3.5-6-32.
(y) This subsection applies to Monroe County. Except as provided
in subsection (p), if an ordinance is adopted under IC 6-3.5-6-33, the
sum of the county economic development income tax rate and the
county option income tax rate that are in effect on January 1 of a year
may not exceed one and twenty-five hundredths percent (1.25%).
(z) This subsection applies to Perry County. Except as provided in
subsection (p), if an ordinance is adopted under section 27.5 of this
chapter, the county economic development income tax rate plus the
county option income tax rate that is in effect on January 1 of a year
may not exceed one and seventy-five hundredths percent (1.75%).
(b) As used in this subsection, "homestead" means a homestead that is eligible for a standard deduction under IC 6-1.1-12-37. Except as provided in sections 15, 23, 25, 26, 27, and 27.5 of this chapter, revenues from the county economic development income tax may be used as follows:
(1) By a county, city, or town for economic development projects, for paying, notwithstanding any other law, under a written agreement all or a part of the interest owed by a private developer or user on a loan extended by a financial institution or other lender to the developer or user if the proceeds of the loan are or are to be used to finance an economic development project, for the retirement of bonds under section 14 of this chapter for economic development projects, for leases under section 21 of this chapter, or for leases or bonds entered into or issued prior to the date the economic development income tax was imposed if the purpose of the lease or bonds would have qualified as a purpose under this chapter at the time the lease was entered into or the bonds were issued.
(2) By a county, city, or town for:
(A) the construction or acquisition of, or remedial action with respect to, a capital project for which the unit is empowered to issue general obligation bonds or establish a fund under any statute listed in IC 6-1.1-18.5-9.8;
(B) the retirement of bonds issued under any provision of Indiana law for a capital project;
(C) the payment of lease rentals under any statute for a capital project;
(D) contract payments to a nonprofit corporation whose primary corporate purpose is to assist government in planning and implementing economic development projects;
(E) operating expenses of a governmental entity that plans or implements economic development projects;
(F) to the extent not otherwise allowed under this chapter, funding substance removal or remedial action in a designated unit; or
(G) funding of a revolving fund established under IC 5-1-14-14.
(3) By a county, city, or town for any lawful purpose for which money in any of its other funds may be used.
(4) By a city or county described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(b) for making transfers required by IC 36-7.5-4-2. If the county economic development income tax rate is increased after April 30, 2005, in
more municipalities in the county have become members of the
northwest Indiana regional development authority as authorized
by IC 36-7.5-2-3(i), the county treasurer shall continue to transfer
the three million five hundred thousand dollars ($3,500,000) to
the treasurer of the northwest Indiana regional development
authority under IC 36-7.5-4-2 before certified distributions are
made to the county or any cities or towns in the county. In a
Porter County, having a population of more than one hundred
forty-five thousand (145,000) but less than one hundred
forty-eight thousand (148,000), all of the tax revenue that results
each year from the tax rate increase that is in excess of the first
three million five hundred thousand dollars ($3,500,000) that
results each year from the tax rate increase must be used by the
county and cities and towns in the county for homestead credits
under subdivision (5).
(5) This subdivision applies only in a Porter County. having a
population of more than one hundred forty-five thousand
(145,000) but less than one hundred forty-eight thousand
(148,000). All of the tax revenue that results each year from a tax
rate increase described in subdivision (4) that is in excess of the
first three million five hundred thousand dollars ($3,500,000) that
results each year from the tax rate increase must be used by the
county and cities and towns in the county for homestead credits
under this subdivision. The following apply to homestead credits
provided under this subdivision:
(A) The homestead credits must be applied uniformly to
provide a homestead credit for homesteads in the county, city,
or town.
(B) The homestead credits shall be treated for all purposes as
property tax levies.
(C) The homestead credits shall be applied to the net property
taxes due on the homestead after the application of all other
assessed value deductions or property tax deductions and
credits that apply to the amount owed under IC 6-1.1.
(D) The department of local government finance shall
determine the homestead credit percentage for a particular
year based on the amount of county economic development
income tax revenue that will be used under this subdivision to
provide homestead credits in that year.
(6) This subdivision applies only in a Lake County. having a
population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less
than seven hundred thousand (700,000). A The county or a city
or town in the county may use county economic development
income tax revenue to provide homestead credits in the county,
city, or town. The following apply to homestead credits provided
under this subdivision:
(A) The county, city, or town fiscal body must adopt an
ordinance authorizing the homestead credits. The ordinance
must specify the amount of county economic development
income tax revenue that will be used to provide homestead
credits in the following year.
(B) A The county, city, or town fiscal body that adopts an
ordinance under this subdivision must forward a copy of the
ordinance to the county auditor and the department of local
government finance not more than thirty (30) days after the
ordinance is adopted.
(C) The homestead credits must be applied uniformly to
increase the homestead credit under IC 6-1.1-20.9 (repealed)
for homesteads in the county, city, or town (for property taxes
first due and payable before January 1, 2009) or to provide a
homestead credit for homesteads in the county, city, or town
(for property taxes first due and payable after December 31,
2008).
(D) The homestead credits shall be treated for all purposes as
property tax levies.
(E) The homestead credits shall be applied to the net property
taxes due on the homestead after the application of all other
assessed value deductions or property tax deductions and
credits that apply to the amount owed under IC 6-1.1.
(F) The department of local government finance shall
determine the homestead credit percentage for a particular
year based on the amount of county economic development
income tax revenue that will be used under this subdivision to
provide homestead credits in that year.
(7) For a regional venture capital fund established under section
13.5 of this chapter or a local venture capital fund established
under section 13.6 of this chapter.
(8) This subdivision applies only to a LaPorte County, if:
(A) that has a population of more than one hundred ten
thousand (110,000) but less than one hundred fifteen thousand
(115,000); and
(B) in which:
(i) (A) the county fiscal body has adopted an ordinance under
IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) providing that the county is joining the
northwest Indiana regional development authority; and
(ii) (B) the fiscal body of the city described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e)
has adopted an ordinance under IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) providing
that the city is joining the development authority.
Revenue from the county economic development income tax may
be used by a the county or a city described in this subdivision for
making transfers required by IC 36-7.5-4-2. In addition, if the
county economic development income tax rate is increased after
June 30, 2006, in the county, the first three million five hundred
thousand dollars ($3,500,000) of the tax revenue that results each
year from the tax rate increase shall be used by the county only to
make the county's transfer required by IC 36-7.5-4-2. The first
three million five hundred thousand dollars ($3,500,000) of the
tax revenue that results each year from the tax rate increase shall
be paid by the county treasurer to the treasurer of the northwest
Indiana regional development authority under IC 36-7.5-4-2
before certified distributions are made to the county or any cities
or towns in the county under this chapter from the tax revenue
that results each year from the tax rate increase. All of the tax
revenue that results each year from the tax rate increase that is in
excess of the first three million five hundred thousand dollars
($3,500,000) that results each year from the tax rate increase must
be used by the county and cities and towns in the county for
homestead credits under subdivision (9).
(9) This subdivision applies only to a LaPorte County. described
in subdivision (8). All of the tax revenue that results each year
from a tax rate increase described in subdivision (8) that is in
excess of the first three million five hundred thousand dollars
($3,500,000) that results each year from the tax rate increase must
be used by the county and cities and towns in the county for
homestead credits under this subdivision. The following apply to
homestead credits provided under this subdivision:
(A) The homestead credits must be applied uniformly to
provide a homestead credit for homesteads in the county, city,
or town.
(B) The homestead credits shall be treated for all purposes as
property tax levies.
(C) The homestead credits shall be applied to the net property
taxes due on the homestead after the application of all other
assessed value deductions or property tax deductions and
credits that apply to the amount owed under IC 6-1.1.
(D) The department of local government finance shall
determine the homestead credit percentage for a particular
year based on the amount of county economic development
income tax revenue that will be used under this subdivision to
provide homestead credits in that year.
(c) As used in this section, an economic development project is any
project that:
(1) the county, city, or town determines will:
(A) promote significant opportunities for the gainful
employment of its citizens;
(B) attract a major new business enterprise to the unit; or
(C) retain or expand a significant business enterprise within
the unit; and
(2) involves an expenditure for:
(A) the acquisition of land;
(B) interests in land;
(C) site improvements;
(D) infrastructure improvements;
(E) buildings;
(F) structures;
(G) rehabilitation, renovation, and enlargement of buildings
and structures;
(H) machinery;
(I) equipment;
(J) furnishings;
(K) facilities;
(L) administrative expenses associated with such a project,
including contract payments authorized under subsection
(b)(2)(D);
(M) operating expenses authorized under subsection (b)(2)(E);
or
(N) to the extent not otherwise allowed under this chapter,
substance removal or remedial action in a designated unit;
or any combination of these.
(d) If there are bonds outstanding that have been issued under
section 14 of this chapter or leases in effect under section 21 of this
chapter, a the county or a city or town may not expend money from its
economic development income tax fund for a purpose authorized under
subsection (b)(3) in a manner that would adversely affect owners of the
outstanding bonds or payment of any lease rentals due.
(c), on May 1 of each year, one-half (1/2) of each county's certified
distribution for a calendar year shall be distributed from its account
established under section 10 of this chapter to the county treasurer. The
other one-half (1/2) shall be distributed on November 1 of that calendar
year.
(b) This subsection applies to a Porter County, having a population
of more than one hundred forty-five thousand (145,000) but less than
one hundred forty-eight thousand (148,000), if the ordinance imposing
the tax is adopted before July 1 of a year. Notwithstanding section 11
of this chapter, the initial certified distribution certified for a county
under section 11 of this chapter shall be distributed to the county
treasurer from the account established for the county under section 10
of this chapter according to the following schedule during the eighteen
(18) month period beginning on July 1 of the year in which the county
initially adopts an ordinance under section 5 of this chapter:
(1) One-fourth (1/4) on October 1 of the year in which the
ordinance was adopted.
(2) One-fourth (1/4) on January 1 of the calendar year following
the year in which the ordinance was adopted.
(3) One-fourth (1/4) on May 1 of the calendar year following the
year in which the ordinance was adopted.
(4) One-fourth (1/4) on November 1 of the calendar year
following the year in which the ordinance was adopted.
The county auditor and county treasurer shall distribute amounts
received under this subsection to a county and each city or town in the
county in the same proportions as are set forth in section 12 of this
chapter. Certified distributions made to the county treasurer for
calendar years following the eighteen (18) month period described in
this subsection shall be made as provided in subsection (a).
(c) Before July 1 of each year, a county's certified distribution for
additional homestead credits under section 25 or 26 of this chapter for
the year shall be distributed from the county's account established
under section 10 of this chapter.
(d) All distributions from an account established under section 10
of this chapter shall be made by warrants issued by the auditor of state
to the treasurer of state ordering the appropriate payments.
(b) In addition to the rates permitted by section 5 of this chapter, the
county council may impose the county economic development income
tax at a rate of twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%) on the adjusted
gross income of county taxpayers if the county council makes the
finding and determination set forth in subsection (c).
(c) In order to impose the county economic development income tax
as provided in this section, the county council must adopt an ordinance
finding and determining that revenues from the county economic
development income tax are needed to pay the costs of:
(1) financing, constructing, acquiring, renovating, and equipping
the county courthouse, and financing and renovating the former
county hospital for additional office space, educational facilities,
nonsecure juvenile facilities, and other county functions,
including the repayment of bonds issued, or leases entered into for
constructing, acquiring, renovating, and equipping the county
courthouse and for renovating the former county hospital for
additional office space, educational facilities, nonsecure juvenile
facilities, and other county functions;
(2) financing constructing, acquiring, renovating, and equipping
buildings for a volunteer fire department (as defined in
IC 36-8-12-2) that provides services in any part of the county; and
(3) financing constructing, acquiring, and renovating firefighting
apparatus or other related equipment for a volunteer fire
department (as defined in IC 36-8-12-2) that provides services in
any part of the county.
(d) If the county council makes a determination under subsection
(c), the county council may adopt a tax rate under subsection (b). The
tax rate may not be imposed at a rate or for a time greater than is
necessary to pay for the purposes described in this section.
(e) The county treasurer shall establish a county option tax revenue
fund to be used only for the purposes described in this section. County
economic development income tax revenues derived from the tax rate
imposed under this section shall be deposited in the county option tax
revenue fund before making a certified distribution under section 11 of
this chapter.
(f) County economic development income tax revenues derived
from the tax rate imposed under this section:
(1) may only be used for the purposes described in this section;
(2) may not be considered by the department of local government
finance in determining the county's maximum permissible
property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5; and
(3) may be pledged to the repayment of bonds issued, or leases
entered into, for the purposes described in subsection (c).
(g)
(1) unique fiscal challenges to finance the operations of county government due to the county's ongoing obligation to repay amounts received by the county due to an overpayment of the county's certified distribution under IC 6-3.5-1.1-9 for a prior year; and
(2) unique capital financing needs related to the purposes described in subsection (c).
(b) The county council may by ordinance determine that, in order to promote the development of libraries in the county and thereby encourage economic development, it is necessary to use economic development income tax revenue to replace library property taxes in the county. However, a county council may adopt an ordinance under this subsection only if all territory in the county is included in a library district.
(c) If the county council makes a determination under subsection (b), the county council may designate the county economic development income tax revenue generated by the tax rate adopted under section 5 of this chapter, or revenue generated by a portion of the tax rate, as revenue that will be used to replace public library property taxes imposed by public libraries in the county. The county council may not designate for library property tax replacement purposes any county economic development income tax revenue that is generated by a tax rate of more than fifteen-hundredths percent (0.15%).
(d) The county treasurer shall establish a library property tax replacement fund to be used only for the purposes described in this section. County economic development income tax revenues derived from the portion of the tax rate designated for property tax replacement credits under subsection (c) shall be deposited in the library property tax replacement fund before certified distributions are made under section 12 of this chapter. Any interest earned on money in the library property tax replacement fund shall be credited to the library property tax replacement fund.
(e) The amount of county economic development income tax revenue dedicated to providing library property tax replacement credits shall, in the manner prescribed in this section, be allocated to public libraries operating in the county and shall be used by those public
libraries as property tax replacement credits. The amount of property
tax replacement credits that each public library in the county is entitled
to receive during a calendar year under this section equals the lesser of:
(1) the product of:
(A) the amount of revenue deposited by the county auditor in
the library property tax replacement fund; multiplied by
(B) a fraction described as follows:
(i) The numerator of the fraction equals the sum of the total
property taxes that would have been collected by the public
library during the previous calendar year from taxpayers
located within the library district if the property tax
replacement under this section had not been in effect.
(ii) The denominator of the fraction equals the sum of the
total property taxes that would have been collected during
the previous year from taxpayers located within the county
by all public libraries that are eligible to receive property tax
replacement credits under this section if the property tax
replacement under this section had not been in effect; or
(2) the total property taxes that would otherwise be collected by
the public library for the calendar year if the property tax
replacement credit under this section were not in effect.
The department of local government finance shall make any
adjustments necessary to account for the expansion of a library district.
However, a public library is eligible to receive property tax
replacement credits under this section only if it has entered into
reciprocal borrowing agreements with all other public libraries in the
county. If the total amount of county economic development income
tax revenue deposited by the county auditor in the library property tax
replacement fund for a calendar year exceeds the total property tax
liability that would otherwise be imposed for public libraries in the
county for the year, the excess shall remain in the library property tax
replacement fund and shall be used for library property tax replacement
purposes in the following calendar year.
(f) Notwithstanding subsection (e), if a public library did not impose
a property tax levy during the previous calendar year, that public
library is entitled to receive a part of the property tax replacement
credits to be distributed for the calendar year. The amount of property
tax replacement credits the public library is entitled to receive during
the calendar year equals the product of:
(1) the amount of revenue deposited in the library property tax
replacement fund; multiplied by
(2) a fraction. The numerator of the fraction equals the budget of
the public library for that calendar year. The denominator of the
fraction equals the aggregate budgets of public libraries in the
county for that calendar year.
If for a calendar year a public library is allocated a part of the property
tax replacement credits under this subsection, then the amount of
property tax credits distributed to other public libraries in the county
for the calendar year shall be reduced by the amount to be distributed
as property tax replacement credits under this subsection. The
department of local government finance shall make any adjustments
required by this subsection and provide the adjustments to the county
auditor.
(g) The department of local government finance shall inform the
county auditor of the amount of property tax replacement credits that
each public library in the county is entitled to receive under this
section. The county auditor shall certify to each public library the
amount of property tax replacement credits that the public library is
entitled to receive during that calendar year. The county auditor shall
also certify these amounts to the county treasurer.
(h) A public library receiving property tax replacement credits under
this section shall allocate the credits among each fund for which a
distinct property tax levy is imposed. The amount that must be
allocated to each fund equals:
(1) the amount of property tax replacement credits provided to the
public library under this section; multiplied by
(2) the amount determined in STEP THREE of the following
formula:
STEP ONE: Determine the property taxes that would have
been collected for each fund by the public library during the
previous calendar year if the property tax replacement under
this section had not been in effect.
STEP TWO: Determine the sum of the total property taxes that
would have been collected for all funds by the public library
during the previous calendar year if the property tax
replacement under this section had not been in effect.
STEP THREE: Divide the STEP ONE amount by the STEP
TWO amount.
However, if a public library did not impose a property tax levy during
the previous calendar year or did not impose a property tax levy for a
particular fund during the previous calendar year, but the public library
is imposing a property tax levy in the current calendar year or is
imposing a property tax levy for the particular fund in the current
calendar year, the department of local government finance shall adjust
the amount of property tax replacement credits allocated among the
various funds of the public library and shall provide the adjustment to
the county auditor. If a public library receiving property tax
replacement credits under this section does not impose a property tax
levy for a particular fund that is first due and payable in a calendar year
in which the property tax replacement credits are being distributed, the
public library is not required to allocate to that fund a part of the
property tax replacement credits to be distributed to the public library.
Notwithstanding IC 6-1.1-20-1.1(1), a public library that receives
property tax replacement credits under this section is subject to the
procedures for the issuance of bonds set forth in IC 6-1.1-20.
(i) For each public library that receives property tax credits under
this section, the department of local government finance shall certify
to the county auditor the property tax rate applicable to each fund after
the property tax replacement credits are allocated.
(j) A public library shall treat property tax replacement credits
received during a particular calendar year under this section as a part
of the public library's property tax levy for each fund for that same
calendar year for purposes of fixing the public library's budget and for
purposes of the property tax levy limits imposed by IC 6-1.1-18.5.
(k) For the purpose of computing and distributing certified
distributions under IC 6-3.5-1.1 and tax revenue under IC 6-5.5 or
IC 6-6-5, the property tax replacement credits that are received under
this section shall be treated as though they were property taxes that
were due and payable during that same calendar year.
(b) In addition to the rates permitted by section 5 of this chapter, the county council may impose the county economic development income tax at a rate of twenty-five hundredths percent (0.25%) on the adjusted gross income of county taxpayers if the county council makes the finding and determination set forth in subsection (c).
(c) In order to impose the county economic development income tax as provided in this section, the county council must adopt an ordinance finding and determining that revenues from the county economic development income tax are needed to pay the costs of financing, constructing, acquiring, renovating, and equipping a county jail including the repayment of bonds issued, or leases entered into, for constructing, acquiring, renovating, and equipping a county jail.
(d) If the county council makes a determination under subsection (c), the county council may adopt a tax rate under subsection (b). The tax rate may not be imposed at a rate or for a time greater than is necessary to pay the costs of financing, constructing, acquiring, renovating, and equipping a county jail.
(e) The county treasurer shall establish a county jail revenue fund to be used only for the purposes described in this section. County economic development income tax revenues derived from the tax rate imposed under this section shall be deposited in the county jail revenue fund before making a certified distribution under section 11 of this chapter.
(f) County economic development income tax revenues derived from the tax rate imposed under this section:
(1) may only be used for the purposes described in this section;
(2) may not be considered by the department of local government finance in determining the county's maximum permissible property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5; and
(3) may be pledged to the repayment of bonds issued, or leases entered into, for the purposes described in subsection (c).
(b) The board of managers shall be composed of eleven (11) members as follows:
(1) Six (6) appointed by the mayor of the city having the largest population in the county, one (1) of whom shall be from the hotel motel industry.
(2) Three (3) appointed by the mayor of the city having the second largest population in the county, one (1) of whom may be from the hotel motel industry.
(3) Two (2) appointed by the board of county commissioners of such county, one (1) of whom shall be from the hotel motel industry.
(c) Except for the members first appointed, each member of the board of managers shall serve for a term of two (2) years commencing on the fifteenth day of the January following their appointment and until their successors are appointed and are qualified.
(d) The two (2) members first appointed by the board of commissioners shall serve from the date of their appointment staggered
terms as follows:
(1) One (1) to January 15 of the year following the appointment.
(2) One (1) to January 15 of the second year following the
appointment.
(e) Three (3) of the members first appointed by the mayor of the city
having the largest population in the county and the three (3) members
first appointed by the mayor of the city having the second largest
population in the county shall serve from the date of their appointment
as follows:
(1) One (1) appointed by each mayor to January 15 of the year
following the appointment.
(2) Two (2) appointed by each mayor to January 15 of the second
year following their appointment.
(f) The three (3) remaining members first appointed by the mayor
of the city having the largest population in the county shall serve to
January 15 of the second year following their appointment.
(g) At the end of the term of any member of the board of managers,
the person or body making the original appointment may reappoint
such person whose term has expired or appoint a new member for a full
two (2) year term.
(h) If a vacancy occurs in the board of managers during any term, a
successor for the vacancy shall be appointed by the person or body
making the original appointment, and such successor shall serve for the
remainder of the vacated term.
(i) Any member of the board of managers may be removed for cause
by the person or body making the original appointment.
(j) No more than two (2) members of the board of managers
appointed by the mayor of the city with the second largest population
in the county shall be of the same political party. No more than three
(3) of the board of managers appointed by the mayor of the city having
the largest population in the county shall be of the same political party.
(k) Each member of the board of managers, before entering upon his
the member's duties, shall take and subscribe an oath of office in the
usual form, to be endorsed upon his the member's certificate of
appointment, which shall be promptly filed with the county's circuit
court clerk. of the circuit court of the county. Each member of the
board of managers must be a resident of the county during his the
member's entire term. Such member shall receive no salary, but shall
be entitled to reimbursement for any expenses necessarily incurred in
the performance of his the member's duties.
population of more than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000)
(250,000) but less than three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000),
(270,000), there shall be levied each year a tax on every person
engaged in the business of renting or furnishing, for periods of less than
thirty (30) days, any room or rooms, lodgings, or accommodations in
any commercial hotel, motel, inn, tourist camp, or tourist cabin. Such
tax shall be at the rate of six percent (6%) on the gross income derived
from lodging income only and shall be in addition to the state gross
retail tax imposed on such persons by IC 6-2.5. The tax shall be
reported on forms approved by the county treasurer, and shall be paid
quarterly to the county treasurer not more than twenty (20) days after
the end of the quarter in which the tax is collected. All provisions of
IC 6-2.5 relating to rights, duties, liabilities, procedures, penalties,
exemptions, and definitions apply to the imposition of the tax imposed
by this section except as otherwise provided by this chapter, and except
that the county treasurer, and not the department of state revenue, is
responsible for administration of the tax. All provisions of IC 6-8.1
apply to the county treasurer with respect to the tax imposed by this
section in the same manner that they apply to the department of state
revenue with respect to the other listed taxes under IC 6-8.1-1-1.
(b) The tax imposed under subsection (a) does not apply to the
renting or furnishing of rooms, lodgings, or accommodations to a
person for a period of thirty (30) days or more.
(b) The Lake County convention and visitor bureau shall establish a convention, tourism, and visitor promotion fund (referred to in this chapter as the "promotion fund"). The county treasurer shall transfer to the Lake County convention and visitor bureau for deposit in the promotion fund thirty-five percent (35%) of the first one million two hundred thousand dollars ($1,200,000) of revenue received from the tax imposed under this chapter in each year. The promotion fund
consists of:
(1) money in the promotion fund on June 30, 2005;
(2) revenue deposited in the promotion fund under this subsection
after June 30, 2005; and
(3) investment income earned on the promotion fund's assets.
Money in the funds established by the bureau may be expended to
promote and encourage conventions, trade shows, special events,
recreation, and visitors. Money may be paid from the funds established
by the bureau, by claim in the same manner as municipalities may pay
claims under IC 5-11-10-1.6.
(c) This subsection applies to the first one million two hundred
thousand dollars ($1,200,000) of revenue received from the tax
imposed under this chapter in each year. During each year, the county
treasurer shall transfer to Indiana University-Northwest forty-four and
thirty-three hundredths percent (44.33%) of the revenue received under
this chapter for that year to be used as follows:
(1) Seventy-five percent (75%) of the revenue received under this
subsection may be used only for the university's medical
education programs.
(2) Twenty-five percent (25%) of the revenue received under this
subsection may be used only for the university's allied health
education programs.
(d) This subsection applies to the first one million two hundred
thousand dollars ($1,200,000) of revenue received from the tax
imposed under this chapter in each year. During each year, the county
treasurer shall allocate among the cities and towns throughout the
county nine percent (9%) of the revenue received under this chapter for
that year as follows:
(1) Ten percent (10%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be distributed to cities having a population of more than
ninety eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one
hundred five eighty thousand (105,000). four hundred (80,400).
(2) Ten percent (10%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be distributed to cities having a population of more than
seventy-five eighty thousand (75,000) five hundred (80,500) but
less than ninety one hundred thousand (90,000). (100,000).
(3) Ten percent (10%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be distributed to cities having a population of more than
thirty-two twenty-nine thousand (32,000) six hundred (29,600)
but less than thirty-two twenty-nine thousand eight nine hundred
(32,800). (29,900).
(4) Seventy percent (70%) of the revenue covered by this
subsection shall be distributed in equal amounts to each town and
each city not receiving a distribution under subdivisions (1)
through (3).
The money distributed under this subsection may be used only for
tourism and economic development projects. The county treasurer shall
make the distributions on or before December 1 of each year.
(e) This subsection applies to the first one million two hundred
thousand dollars ($1,200,000) of revenue received from the tax
imposed under this chapter in each year. During each year, the county
treasurer shall transfer to Purdue University-Calumet nine percent (9%)
of the revenue received under this chapter for that year. The money
received by Purdue University-Calumet may be used by the university
only for nursing education programs.
(f) This subsection applies to the first one million two hundred
thousand dollars ($1,200,000) of revenue received from the tax
imposed under this chapter in each year. During each year, the county
treasurer shall transfer two and sixty-seven hundredths percent (2.67%)
of the revenue received under this chapter for that year to the following
cities:
(1) Fifty percent (50%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be transferred to cities having a population of more than
ninety eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one
hundred five eighty thousand (105,000). four hundred (80,400).
(2) Fifty percent (50%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be transferred to cities having a population of more than
seventy-five eighty thousand (75,000) five hundred (80,500) but
less than ninety one hundred thousand (90,000). (100,000).
Money transferred under this subsection may be used only for
convention facilities located within the city. In addition, the money may
be used only for facility marketing, sales, and public relations
programs. Money transferred under this subsection may not be used for
salaries, facility operating costs, or capital expenditures related to the
convention facilities. The county treasurer shall make the transfers on
or before December 1 of each year.
(g) This subsection applies to the revenue received from the tax
imposed under this chapter in each year that exceeds one million two
hundred thousand dollars ($1,200,000). During each year, the county
treasurer shall distribute money in the promotion fund as follows:
(1) Eighty-five percent (85%) of the revenue covered by this
subsection shall be deposited in the convention, tourism, and
visitor promotion fund. The money deposited in the fund under
this subdivision may be used only for the purposes for which
other money in the fund may be used.
(2) Five percent (5%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be transferred to Purdue University-Calumet. The money
received by Purdue University-Calumet under this subdivision
may be used by the university only for nursing education
programs.
(3) Five percent (5%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be transferred to Indiana University-Northwest. The money
received by Indiana University-Northwest under this subdivision
may be used only for the university's medical education programs.
(4) Five percent (5%) of the revenue covered by this subsection
shall be transferred to Indiana University-Northwest. The money
received by Indiana University-Northwest under this subdivision
may be used only for the university's allied health education
programs.
(h) This subsection applies only to the distribution of revenue
received from the tax imposed under section 1 of this chapter from
hotels, motels, inns, tourist camps, tourist cabins, and other lodgings or
accommodations built or refurbished after June 30, 1993, that are
located in the largest city of the county. During each year, the county
treasurer shall transfer:
(1) seventy-five percent (75%) of the revenues under this
subsection to the department of public safety; and
(2) twenty-five percent (25%) of the revenues under this
subsection to the division of physical and economic development;
of the largest city of the county.
(i) The Lake County convention and visitor bureau shall assist the
county treasurer, as needed, with the calculation of the amounts that
must be deposited and transferred under this section.
(110,000) (111,000) but less than one hundred fifteen thousand
(115,000).
(b) Money in the innkeeper's tax fund shall be distributed as follows:
(1) Thirty percent (30%) shall be distributed as follows:
(A) Before July 1, 2015, and after June 30, 2017, to the department of natural resources for the development of projects in the state park on the county's largest river, including its tributaries.
(B) For the period July 1, 2015, through June 30, 2017, to the treasurer of state for deposit in the state general fund.
(2) Forty percent (40%) shall be distributed to the commission to carry out its purposes, including making any distributions or payments to the Lafayette - West Lafayette Convention and Visitors Bureau, Inc.
(3) Ten percent (10%) shall be distributed to a community development corporation that serves a metropolitan area in the county that includes:
(A) a city having a population of more than
(B) a city having a population of more than
for the community development corporation's use in tourism, recreation, and economic development activities.
(4) Ten percent (10%) shall be distributed to Historic Prophetstown to be used by Historic Prophetstown for carrying
out its purposes.
(5) Ten percent (10%) shall be distributed to the Wabash River
Enhancement Corporation to assist the Wabash River
Enhancement Corporation in carrying out its purposes.
(c) An advisory commission consisting of the following members is
established:
(1) The director of the department of natural resources or the
director's designee.
(2) The public finance director or the public finance director's
designee.
(3) A member appointed by the Native American Indian affairs
commission.
(4) A member appointed by Historic Prophetstown.
(5) A member appointed by the community development
corporation described in subsection (b)(3).
(6) A member appointed by the Wabash River Enhancement
Corporation.
(7) A member appointed by the commission.
(8) A member appointed by the county fiscal body.
(9) A member appointed by the town board of the town of
Battleground.
(10) A member appointed by the mayor of the city of Lafayette.
(11) A member appointed by the mayor of the city of West
Lafayette.
(d) The following apply to the advisory commission:
(1) The governor shall appoint a member of the advisory
commission as chairman of the advisory commission.
(2) Six (6) members of the advisory commission constitute a
quorum. The affirmative votes of at least six (6) advisory
commission members are necessary for the advisory commission
to take official action other than to adjourn or to meet to hear
reports or testimony.
(3) The advisory commission shall make recommendations
concerning the use of any proceeds of bonds issued to finance the
development of Prophetstown State Park.
(4) Members of the advisory commission who are state
employees:
(A) are not entitled to any salary per diem; and
(B) are entitled to reimbursement for traveling expenses as
provided under IC 4-13-1-4 and to reimbursement for other
expenses actually incurred in connection with the member's
duties as provided in the state policies and procedures
established by the Indiana department of administration and
approved by the budget agency.
(e) The Indiana finance authority, in its capacity as the recreational
development commission, may issue bonds for the development of
Prophetstown State Park under IC 14-14-1.
five hundred (32,500).
to a county having a population of more than one hundred eighteen
fifteen thousand (118,000) (115,000) but less than one hundred twenty
twenty-five thousand (120,000). (125,000).
(b) The county described in subsection (a) is unique because:
(1) governmental entities and nonprofit organizations in the county have successfully undertaken cooperative efforts to promote tourism and economic development; and
(2) several unique tourist attractions are located in the county, including:
(A) the Indiana basketball hall of fame;
(B) the Wilbur Wright birthplace memorial; and
(C) a historic gymnasium.
(c) The presence of these unique attractions in the county has:
(1) increased the number of visitors to the county;
(2) generated increased sales at restaurants and other retail establishments selling food in the county; and
(3) placed increased demands on all local governments for services needed to support tourism and economic development in the county.
(d) The use of food and beverage tax revenues arising in part from the presence of the attractions identified in subsection (b)(2) to support tourism and economic development in the county permits governmental units in the county to diversify the revenue sources for which local government improvements and services are funded.
(b) Money in the fund established under section 8 of this chapter shall be used by the county for the financing, construction, renovation, improvement, equipping, or maintenance of the following capital improvements:
(1) Sanitary sewers or wastewater treatment facilities that serve economic development purposes.
(2) Drainage or flood control facilities that serve economic development purposes.
(3) Road improvements used on an access road for an industrial park that serve economic development purposes.
(4) A covered horse show arena.
(5) A historic birthplace memorial.
(6) A historic gymnasium and community center in a town in the county with a population greater than two thousand (2,000) but less than two thousand
(7) Main street renovation and picnic and park areas in a town in the county with a population greater than two thousand (2,000) but less than two thousand
(8) A community park and cultural center.
(9) Projects for which the county decides after July 1, 1994, to:
(A) expend money in the fund established under section 8 of this chapter; or
(B) issue bonds or other obligations or enter into leases under section 11.5 of this chapter;
after the projects described in subdivisions (1) through (8) have been funded.
(10) An ambulance.
Money in the fund may not be used for the operating costs of any of the permissible projects listed in this section. In addition, the county may not issue bonds or enter into leases or other obligations under this chapter after December 31, 2015.
(c) The county capital improvements committee is established to make recommendations to the county fiscal body concerning the use of money in the fund established under section 8 of this chapter. The capital improvements committee consists of the following members:
(1) One (1) resident of the county representing each of the three (3) commissioner districts, appointed by the county executive. Not more than two (2) of the members appointed under this subdivision may be from the same political party.
(2) Two (2) residents of the county, appointed by the county fiscal body. The two (2) appointees may not be from the same political party. One (1) appointee under this subdivision must be a resident of a town in the county with a population greater than two thousand (2,000) but less than two thousand
(3) Two (2) residents of the largest city in the county, appointed by the municipal executive. The two (2) appointees under this subdivision may not be from the same political party. One (1)
appointee must be interested in economic development.
(4) Two (2) residents of the largest city in the county, appointed
by the municipal fiscal body. The two (2) appointees under this
subdivision may not be from the same political party. One (1)
appointee must be interested in tourism.
(d) Except as provided in subsection (e), the term of a member
appointed to the capital improvements committee under subsection (c)
is four (4) years.
(e) The initial terms of office for the members appointed to the
county capital improvements committee under subsection (c) are as
follows:
(1) Of the members appointed under subsection (c)(1), one (1)
member shall be appointed for a term of two (2) years, one (1)
member shall be appointed for three (3) years, and one (1)
member shall be appointed for four (4) years.
(2) Of the members appointed under subsection (c)(2), one (1)
member shall be appointed for two (2) years and one (1) member
shall be appointed for three (3) years.
(3) Of the members appointed under subsection (c)(3), one (1)
member shall be appointed for two (2) years and one (1) member
shall be appointed for three (3) years.
(4) Of the members appointed under subsection (c)(4), one (1)
member shall be appointed for three (3) years and one (1)
member shall be appointed for four (4) years.
(f) At the expiration of a term under subsection (e), the member
whose term expired may be reappointed to the county capital
improvements committee to fill the vacancy caused by the expiration.
(g) The capital improvements committee is abolished on January 1,
2016.
(b) Money deposited in the county economic development project fund before March 1, 1992, shall be transferred to the following:
(1) Fifty percent (50%) of the money deposited shall be
transferred to the fiscal officer of a city having a population of
more than fifty-nine fifty-five thousand seven hundred (59,700)
(55,000) but less than sixty-five sixty thousand (65,000).
(60,000).
(2) Fifty percent (50%) of the money deposited shall be
transferred to the county general fund. Money transferred under
this subdivision shall be used for:
(A) economic development projects in locations other than a
city described in subdivision (1); or
(B) the following purposes:
(i) The financing, construction, or equipping of a secure
detention facility under IC 31-31-8 or IC 31-6-9-5
(repealed).
(ii) All reasonable and necessary architectural, engineering,
legal, financing, accounting, advertising, and supervisory
expenses related to the financing, construction, or equipping
of a facility described in item (i).
(iii) The retiring of any bonds issued, loans obtained, or
lease payments incurred under IC 36-1-10 to finance,
construct, or equip a facility described in item (i).
(c) Except as provided in subsection (d), money deposited in the
county economic development project fund after February 29, 1992,
shall be transferred to the following:
(1) Forty percent (40%) of the money deposited shall be
transferred to the fiscal officer of a city described in subsection
(b)(1).
(2) Forty percent (40%) of the money deposited shall be
transferred to the county general fund. Money transferred under
this subdivision shall be used for the following purposes:
(A) The financing, construction, or equipping of a secure
detention facility under IC 31-31-8 or IC 31-6-9-5 (repealed).
(B) All reasonable and necessary architectural, engineering,
legal, financing, accounting, advertising, and supervisory
expenses related to the financing, construction, or equipping
of a facility described in clause (A).
(C) The retiring of any bonds issued, loans obtained, or lease
payments incurred under IC 36-1-10 to finance, construct, or
equip a facility described in clause (A).
(3) Twenty percent (20%) of the money deposited shall be
transferred to the county general fund. Money transferred under
this subdivision shall be used for economic development projects
in locations other than a city described in subsection (b)(1).
(d) After the retiring of any bonds issued, loans obtained, or lease payments incurred under IC 36-1-10 to finance, construct, or equip a secure detention facility under subsection (c)(2), money deposited in the county economic development project fund after February 29, 1992, shall be transferred to the following:
(1) Seventy percent (70%) of the money deposited shall be transferred to the fiscal officer of a city described in subsection (b)(1).
(2) Thirty percent (30%) of the money deposited shall be transferred to the county general fund. Money transferred under this subdivision shall be used for economic development projects in locations other than a city described in subsection (b)(1).
(e) Money transferred to a city fiscal officer under subsection (b)(1), (c)(1), or (d)(1) shall be credited to a special account to be known as the city economic development account. Money credited to the account shall be used only for those purposes described in IC 6-3.5-7 (the county economic development income tax).
(1) A town:
(A) located in a county having a population of more than
(B) having a population of more than nine thousand (9,000).
(2) A town:
(A) located in a county having a population of more than
(B) having a population of less than one thousand (1,000).
(3) A town:
(A) located in a county having a population of more than one hundred forty thousand
(B) having a population of more than
(4) A town:
(A) located in a county having a population of more than one hundred forty thousand
(B) having a population of more than
(5) A town:
(A) located in a county having a population of more than one hundred forty thousand
(B) having a population of more than
(6) A city having a population of more than eleven thousand
(b) The:
(1) convention, visitor, and tourism promotion fund;
(2) convention and visitor commission;
(3) innkeeper's tax rate; and
(4) tax collection procedures;
established under IC 6-9-18 before July 1, 1999, remain in effect and govern the county's innkeeper's tax until amended under this chapter.
(c) A member of the convention and visitor commission established under IC 6-9-18 before July 1, 1999, shall serve a full term of office. If a vacancy occurs, the appointing authority shall appoint a qualified replacement as provided under this chapter. The appointing authority shall make other subsequent appointments to the commission as provided under this chapter.
(1) A county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand
(700,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
forty-five fifty thousand (145,000) (150,000) but less than one
hundred forty-eight seventy thousand (148,000). (170,000).
(b) The:
(1) convention, visitor, and tourism promotion fund;
(2) convention and visitor commission;
(3) innkeeper's tax rate; and
(4) tax collection procedures;
established under IC 6-9-18 before July 1, 2005, remain in effect and govern the county's innkeeper's tax until amended under this chapter.
(c) A member of the convention and visitor commission established under IC 6-9-18 before July 1, 2005, shall serve a full term of office. If a vacancy occurs, the appointing authority shall appoint a qualified replacement as provided in this chapter. The appointing authority shall make other subsequent appointments to the commission as provided in this chapter.
(1) A consolidated city or its county.
(2) A second class city.
(3) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(4) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(5) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(6) A county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000).
(7) A city having a population of more than
(8) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(9) A county having a population of more than
(b) A county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000) or a township located in such a county that has established a public park with a golf course within its jurisdiction under IC 36-10-3 or IC 36-10-7 may be issued a permit for the retail sale of alcoholic beverages on the premises of any community center within the park, including a clubhouse, social center, or pavilion.
(c) A township that:
(1) is located in a county having a population of more than one hundred five thousand (105,000) but less than one hundred ten thousand (110,000); and
(2) acquires ownership of a golf course;
may permit the retail sale of alcoholic beverages upon the premises of the golf course, if the governing board of the golf course first applies for and secures the necessary permits required by this title.
(d) A township:
(1) having a population of more than thirty-five thousand (35,000) but less than one hundred thousand (100,000); and
(2) located in a county having a population of more than four
hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand
(700,000);
may be issued a permit for the retail sale of alcoholic beverages on the
premises of any community center or social center that is located
within the township and operated by the township.
(e) A city that owns a golf course may permit the retail sale of
alcoholic beverages upon the premises of the golf course if the
governing board of the golf course first applies for and secures the
necessary permits required by this title.
(f) A city that:
(1) has a population of more than thirty-two twenty-nine
thousand (32,000) six hundred (29,600) but less than thirty-two
twenty-nine thousand eight nine hundred (32,800); (29,900); and
(2) owns or leases a marina;
may permit the retail sale of alcoholic beverages upon the premises of
the marina if the governing board of the marina first applies for and
secures the necessary permits required by this title. The permit may
include the carryout sale of alcoholic beverages in accordance with
IC 7.1-3-4-6(c), IC 7.1-3-9-9(c), IC 7.1-3-14-4(c), and 905 IAC 1-29
but may not include at-home delivery of alcoholic beverages.
(g) A city listed in this subsection that owns a marina may be issued
a permit for the retail sale of alcoholic beverages on the premises of the
marina. The permit may include the carryout sale of alcoholic
beverages in accordance with IC 7.1-3-4-6(c), IC 7.1-3-9-9(c),
IC 7.1-3-14-4(c), and 905 IAC 1-29 but may not include at-home
delivery of alcoholic beverages. However, the city must apply for and
secure the necessary permits that this title requires. This subsection
applies to the following cities:
(1) A city having a population of more than ninety eighty
thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five eighty
thousand (105,000). four hundred (80,400).
(2) A city having a population of more than seventy-five eighty
thousand (75,000) five hundred (80,500) but less than ninety one
hundred thousand (90,000). (100,000).
(3) A city having a population of more than thirty-two thirty-one
thousand eight hundred (32,800) (31,000) but less than
thirty-three thirty-one thousand (33,000). five hundred (31,500).
(4) A city having a population of more than thirty-three thirty-six
thousand (33,000) eight hundred twenty-five (36,825) but less
than thirty-six forty thousand (36,000). (40,000).
(5) A city having a population of more than twenty-seven
forty-four thousand (27,000) five hundred (44,500) but less than
twenty-seven forty-five thousand four hundred (27,400).
(45,000).
(h) Notwithstanding subsection (a), the commission may issue a
civic center permit to a person that:
(1) by the person's self or in combination with another person is
the proprietor, as owner or lessee, of an entertainment complex;
or
(2) has an agreement with a person described in subdivision (1)
to act as a concessionaire for the entertainment complex for the
full period for which the permit is to be issued.
(1) is located in a city having a population of more than
(2) has been listed in the National Register of Historic Places maintained under the National Historic Preservation Act of 1966, as amended. A permit issued under this subsection may not be transferred.
(b) A permit issued under this section is subject to the quota requirements of IC 7.1-3-22-3.
(b) Notwithstanding subsection (a), if a city of less than twenty thousand (20,000) in population according to the most recent federal decennial census, constituting a public water utility, and acting as a public utility prior to May 1, 1913, either as such city, or by any commercial association, chamber of commerce, or committee with the consent of such city, entered into any agreement with any person
engaged in manufacturing any articles of commerce to furnish free
water for a certain limited time as an inducement to such person so
engaged in manufacturing to locate the establishment or manufacturing
plant of such person within such city, such city may carry out such
agreement to furnish free water to such person for the period of time
remaining, as stipulated in such contract. This chapter does not prohibit
any public utility from supplying or furnishing free service or service
at special rates to any municipality, or any institution or agency of such
municipality, in cases where the supplying or furnishing of such free
service or service at special rates is stipulated in any provision of the
franchise under which such public utility was operating before May 16,
1919, or, in the event that such franchise shall have been surrendered,
from supplying or furnishing such free service or service at special
rates until such time as the franchise would have expired had it not
been surrendered under this chapter; and it shall be the duty of any
utility operating under any franchise, stipulating for free service or
service at special rates to the municipality, or any institution or agency
of such municipality, to furnish such free service or service at special
rates.
(c) This subsection applies to a public utility that provides water for
public fire protection services in both a county containing a
consolidated city and in portions of counties that are adjacent to the
county containing a consolidated city. This subsection applies
throughout the territory served by the public utility. In the case of a
public utility furnishing water and beginning on January 1, 1994, the
charges for the production, storage, transmission, sale and delivery, or
furnishing of water for public fire protection purposes shall be included
in the basic rates of the customers of the public utility. However, the
construction cost of any fire hydrant installed after December 31, 1993,
at the request of a municipality, township, county, or other
governmental unit shall be paid for by or on behalf of the municipality,
township, county, or other governmental unit. The change in the
recovery of current revenue authorized by this section shall be reflected
in a new schedule of rates to be filed with the commission at least thirty
(30) days before the time the new schedule of rates is to take effect.
The new schedule of rates shall:
(1) eliminate fire protection charges billed directly to
governmental units, other than charges for the construction cost
for new hydrants installed after December 31, 1993; and
(2) increase the rates charged each customer of the utility, based
on equivalent meter size, by an amount equal to:
(A) the revenues lost from the elimination of such fire
protection charges; divided by
(B) the current number of equivalent five-eighths (5/8) inch
meters.
This change in the recovery of public fire protection costs shall not be
considered to be a general increase in basic rates and charges of the
public utility and is not subject to the notice and hearing requirements
applicable to general rate proceedings. The commission shall approve
the new schedule of rates that are to be effective January 1, 1994.
(d) This subsection applies to a public utility or a municipally
owned water utility that is not subject to subsection (c). Except as
provided in subsection (e), in the case of a public utility or municipally
owned water utility furnishing water, if the governing body of any
municipality within the service area of the utility adopts an ordinance
providing that costs shall be recovered under this subsection, the
charges for the production, storage, transmission, sale and delivery, or
furnishing of water for public fire protection purposes shall be included
in the basic rates of all customers of the utility within the municipality.
However, on or after a date specified in the ordinance, the construction
cost of any fire hydrant installed at the request of a municipality,
township, county, or other governmental unit that adopts an ordinance
under this subsection shall be paid for by or on behalf of the
municipality, township, county, or other governmental unit. The change
in the recovery of current revenue authorized by the ordinance shall be
reflected in a new schedule of rates to be filed with the commission at
least thirty (30) days before the time the new schedule of rates is to take
effect. The new schedule of rates shall:
(1) eliminate fire protection charges billed directly to
governmental units, other than charges for the construction cost
for new hydrants installed on and after the date specified in the
ordinance; and
(2) increase the rates charged each customer of the utility, based
on equivalent meter size, by an amount equal to:
(A) the revenues lost from the elimination of such fire
protection charges; divided by
(B) the current number of equivalent five-eighths (5/8) inch
meters.
This change in the recovery of public fire protection costs shall not be
considered to be a general increase in basic rates and charges of the
utility and is not subject to the notice and hearing requirements
applicable to general rate proceedings. The commission shall approve
the new schedule of rates that are to be effective on a date specified in
the ordinance.
(e) This subsection applies to a municipally owned water utility in a city having a population of more than fifty thousand (50,000) but less than
(f) In the case of a change in the method of recovering public fire protection costs under an ordinance adopted under subsection (d):
(1) on or after July 1, 1997, a customer of the utility located outside the limits of a municipality whose property is not located within one thousand (1,000) feet of a fire hydrant (measured from the hydrant to the nearest point on the property line of the customer) must be excluded from the increase in rates attributable to the change and must not be included in the number of equivalent five-eighths (5/8) inch meters for purposes of subsection (d)(2)(B); or
(2) before July 1, 1997, the commission may:
(A) in the context of a general rate proceeding initiated by the utility; or
(B) upon petition of:
(i) the utility;
(ii) the governmental unit that passed the ordinance; or
(iii) an affected customer;
prospectively exclude public fire protection costs from the rates charged to customers located outside the limits of any municipality whose property is not located within one thousand (1,000) feet of a fire hydrant (measured from the hydrant to the nearest point on the property line of the customer) if the commission authorizes a simultaneous increase in the rates of the utility's other customers to the extent necessary to prevent a loss of revenues to the utility.
An increase in the rates of the utility's other customers under subdivision (2) may not be construed to be a general increase in basic rates and charges of the utility and is not subject to the hearing requirements applicable to general rate proceedings. This subsection does not prohibit the commission from adopting different methods of public fire protection cost recovery for unincorporated areas after notice and hearing within the context of a general rate proceeding or
other appropriate proceeding.
(1) Rates and charges.
(2) Stocks, bonds, notes, or other evidence of indebtedness.
(3) Rules.
(4) The annual report filing requirement.
(b) When the number of patrons served by a withdrawn utility described in section 1.3(a)(1)(A) or 1.3(a)(2)(A) of this chapter reaches five thousand (5,000), the utility:
(1) becomes subject to the annual report filing requirement described in IC 8-1-2-16; and
(2) shall immediately notify the commission of the number of patrons served by the utility.
Upon receiving notice under subdivision (2), the commission may reassert jurisdiction over the utility, in whole or in part, after notice and hearing if the commission finds that the public interest so requires.
(c) As used in this subsection, "utility" refers to a utility described in section 1.3(a)(1)(B) of this chapter that is located in a county having a population of more than sixteen thousand
(1) rates and charges;
(2) rules; and
(3) operating and territorial authority;
that have been or may be established concerning the purchase of water for resale by the complaining utility from the withdrawn utility. The rates and charges described in subdivision (1) are subject to the requirements of IC 8-1-2-125. The burden of proof that the rates and charges described in subdivision (1) comply with IC 8-1-2-125 is on the withdrawn utility.
(1) in the case of a second class city located in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(2) in the case of any other municipality, all the territory within the corporate boundaries of the municipality, or the territory served by the waterworks if larger or smaller than the corporate boundaries.
(1) charged against the municipality; and
(2) paid for in monthly installments as the service accrues out of the current revenues of the municipality, collected or in process of collection, and the tax levy of the municipality made by it to raise money to meet its necessary current expenses.
(b) This subsection applies to a municipality that is subject to IC 8-1-2-103(c), that has adopted an ordinance to become subject to IC 8-1-2-103(d), or that has adopted a plan described in IC 8-1-2-103(d) as prescribed in IC 8-1-2-103(e). The reasonable cost and value of any service rendered to the municipality by the waterworks by furnishing water for public purposes shall be:
(1) charged against the municipality; and
(2) paid for in monthly installments as the service accrues out of the current revenues of the municipality, collected or in process of collection, and the tax levy of the municipality made by it to raise money to meet its necessary current expenses.
Except as provided in subsection (d), the cost and value of maintaining hydrants and other facilities for fire protection shall be excluded from the charges against the municipality and shall be recovered from the other customers of the waterworks beginning on January 1, 1994, in a municipality subject to IC 8-1-2-103(c) and beginning on a date provided in the ordinance for a municipality that adopts an ordinance under IC 8-1-2-103(d). The change in the recovery of current revenue authorized by this section shall be reflected in a schedule of new rates to be filed with the commission at least thirty (30) days before the time the schedule of new rates is to take effect.
(c) The compensation for the service provided to the municipality shall, in the manner prescribed by this chapter, be paid into the separate and special fund created by setting aside the income and revenues of the waterworks and is subject to apportionment to the operating, maintenance, depreciation, and bond and interest redemption accounts.
(d) This subsection applies to a city having a population of more than
(1) In a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(2) In a township having a population of more than
(1) A consolidated city.
(2) A city having a population of more than one hundred
(b) An automated transit district may also be created by the procedures provided in sections 2 and 3 of this chapter.
of members it deems necessary and be appointed by the mayor with the
advice and consent of the common council. Members of a board of
directors of a port authority created by the exclusive action of a county
shall consist of such members as it deems necessary and be appointed
by the county commissioners of such county. Members of a board of
directors of a port authority created by a combination of political
subdivisions shall be divided among such political subdivisions in such
proportions as such political subdivisions may agree and appointed in
the same manner as this section provides for their appointment when
such political subdivision creates its own port authority. When a port
authority is created by a combination of political subdivisions, the
number of directors composing the board shall be determined by
agreement between such political subdivisions.
(b) In the case of a port authority created under section 2 of this
chapter in a county having a population of more than four hundred
thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000),
the board of directors shall consist of seven (7) members, three (3) of
whom shall be appointed by the board of county commissioners, one
(1) each by the mayors of the three (3) cities in the county having the
largest populations, and the mayor of the city having the largest
population shall appoint any remaining member or members. The
board shall be appointed as follows:
(1) The mayors of the three (3) cities in the county having the
largest populations shall each make one (1) appointment.
(2) The board of county commissioners shall make its three (3)
appointments following the naming of the city appointees and
appoint persons of such political faith as to make the board of
directors a bipartisan body.
(3) If a city is entitled to a second appointment, the mayor shall
make the appointment subject to retaining the board's bipartisan
status.
(4) In no event may more than three (3) board members residing
in the same city serve on said board at the same time.
(5) In no event may more than four (4) members of one (1)
political party serve on the board at the same time.
(c) This subsection applies to a port authority created under section
2 of this chapter by the exclusive action of a municipal corporation in
a city having a population of more than seventy-five eighty thousand
(75,000) five hundred (80,500) but less than ninety one hundred
thousand (90,000). (100,000). The board of directors of the port
authority consists of five (5) members appointed as follows:
(1) Three (3) members appointed by the mayor of the city.
(2) Two (2) members appointed by the legislative body of the city.
(d) The appointing authority may at any time remove a director appointed by it for misfeasance, nonfeasance, or malfeasance in office.
(e) At the time of appointment, a director must be a resident of one (1) of the following:
(1) The political subdivision from which the director is appointed.
(2) The county within which the port authority is established.
At all times, a majority of the directors must be residents of the political subdivisions from which the members are appointed.
(f) The directors of any port authority first appointed shall serve staggered terms. Thereafter each successor shall serve for a term of four (4) years, except that any person appointed to fill a vacancy shall be appointed to only the unexpired term and any director shall be eligible for reappointment.
(g) The directors shall elect one (1) of their membership as chairman, and another as vice chairman, and shall designate their terms of office, and shall appoint a secretary who need not be a director. A majority of the board of directors shall constitute a quorum the affirmative vote of which shall be necessary for any action taken by the port authority. No vacancy in the membership of the board shall impair the rights of a quorum to exercise all the rights and perform all the duties of the port authority.
(h) Each member of the board of directors of a port authority shall be entitled to receive from the port authority such sum of money as the board of directors may determine as compensation for the member's service as director and reimbursement for the member's reasonable expenses in the performance of the member's duties.
(1) more than
(2) more than
FOLLOWS [EFFECTIVE APRIL 1, 2012]: Sec. 1. This chapter applies
to a city having a population of more than thirty-two twenty-nine
thousand (32,000) six hundred (29,600) but less than thirty-two
twenty-nine thousand eight nine hundred (32,800). (29,900).
(1) more than
(2) more than
(3) more than
(4) more than
(5) more than
(6) more than eighteen thousand
(7) more than twenty thousand
(8) more than twelve thousand
(9) more than ten thousand (10,000) but less than ten thousand
(10) more than ten thousand seven hundred (10,700) but less than twelve thousand (12,000).
(1) A county having a population of more than
(2) A county having a population of more than
(37,125) but less than thirty-four thirty-seven thousand nine five
hundred fifty (34,950). (37,500).
(3) A county having a population of more than one hundred ten
eleven thousand (110,000) (111,000) but less than one hundred
fifteen thousand (115,000).
(4) A county having a population of more than one hundred
eighty-two eighty-five thousand seven hundred ninety (182,790)
(185,000) but less than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000).
(250,000).
(5) A county having a population of more than two hundred fifty
thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two hundred
seventy thousand (300,000). (270,000).
(6) A county having a population of more than one hundred
forty-five fifty thousand (145,000) (150,000) but less than one
hundred forty-eight seventy thousand (148,000). (170,000).
(7) A county having a population of more than four hundred
thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand
(700,000).
(1) subject to subsection (d), construct, reconstruct, maintain, repair, and operate toll road projects at such locations as shall be approved by the governor;
(2) in accordance with such alignment and design standards as shall be approved by the authority and subject to IC 8-9.5-8-10, issue toll road revenue bonds of the state payable solely from funds pledged for their payment, as authorized by this chapter, to pay the cost of such projects;
(3) finance, develop, construct, reconstruct, improve, or maintain improvements for manufacturing, commercial, or public transportation activities within a county through which a toll road passes;
(4) in cooperation with the Indiana department of transportation or a political subdivision, construct, reconstruct, or finance the
construction or reconstruction of an arterial highway or an arterial
street that is located within a county through which a toll road
passes and that:
(A) interchanges with a toll road project; or
(B) intersects with a road or a street that interchanges with a
toll road project;
(5) finance improvements necessary for developing transportation
corridors in northwestern Indiana; and
(6) exercise these powers in participation with any governmental
entity or with any individual, partnership, limited liability
company, or corporation.
(b) Notwithstanding subsection (a), the authority shall not construct,
maintain, operate, nor contract for the construction, maintenance, or
operation of transient lodging facilities on, or adjacent to, such toll road
projects.
(c) This chapter:
(1) applies to the authority only when acting for the purposes set
forth in this chapter; and
(2) does not apply to the authority when acting under any other
statute for any other purpose.
(d) Before the authority or an operator selected under IC 8-15.5 may
carry out any of the following activities under this chapter, the general
assembly must enact a statute authorizing that activity:
(1) Carrying out construction for Interstate Highway 69 in a
township having a population of more than seventy-five one
hundred thousand (75,000) (100,000) and less than ninety-three
one hundred ten thousand five hundred (93,500). (110,000)
located in a county having a consolidated city.
(2) Imposing tolls on motor vehicles for use of Interstate Highway
69.
(3) Imposing tolls on motor vehicles for use of a nontolled
highway, roadway, or other facility in existence or under
construction on July 1, 2011, including nontolled interstate
highways, U.S. routes, and state routes.
(b) The department may, in any combination, plan, design, develop, construct, reconstruct, maintain, repair, police, finance, and operate tollways, public improvements, and arterial streets and roads at those locations that the governor approves.
(c) The department may, in any combination, plan, design, develop, construct, reconstruct, improve, finance, operate, repair, or maintain public improvements such as roads and streets, sewer lines, water lines, and other utilities if these improvements are:
(1) adjacent or appurtenant to a tollway; or
(2) necessary or desirable for the financing, construction, operation, or maintenance of a tollway.
(d) The department may, in any combination, plan, design, develop, construct, reconstruct, improve, maintain, repair, operate, or finance the construction or reconstruction of an arterial highway or an arterial street that:
(1) is adjacent to, appurtenant to, or interchanges with a tollway; or
(2) intersects with a road or street that interchanges with a tollway.
(e) Before the governor, the department, or an operator may carry out any of the following activities under this chapter, the general assembly must enact a statute authorizing that activity:
(1) Approve the location of a tollway other than a tollway that is approved before July 1, 2011.
(2) Carry out construction for Interstate Highway 69 in a township having a population of more than
(3) Impose tolls on motor vehicles for use of Interstate Highway 69.
(f) Notwithstanding subsection (e), during the period beginning July 1, 2011, and ending June 30, 2021, the general assembly is not required to enact a statute authorizing the governor, the department, or an operator to approve the location of a tollway with respect to the following projects:
(1) A project on which construction begins after June 30, 2011, not including any part of Interstate Highway 69 other than a part described in subdivision (4).
(2) The addition of toll lanes, including high occupancy toll lanes, to a highway, roadway, or other facility in existence on July 1, 2011, if the number of nontolled lanes on the highway, roadway, or facility as of July 1, 2011, does not decrease due to the addition of the toll lanes.
(3) The Illiana Expressway, a limited access facility connecting Interstate Highway 65 in northwestern Indiana with an interstate
highway in Illinois.
(4) A project that is located within a metropolitan planning area
(as defined by 23 U.S.C. 134) and that connects the state of
Indiana with the commonwealth of Kentucky.
(b) Before the authority or the department may issue a request for proposals for or enter into a public-private agreement under this article that would authorize an operator to impose tolls for the operation of motor vehicles on all or part of a project, the general assembly must adopt a statute authorizing the imposition of tolls. However, during the period beginning July 1, 2011, and ending June 30, 2021, and notwithstanding subsection (c), the general assembly is not required to enact a statute authorizing the authority or the department to issue a request for proposals or enter into a public-private agreement to authorize an operator to impose tolls for the operation of motor vehicles on all or part of the following projects:
(1) A project on which construction begins after June 30, 2011, not including any part of Interstate Highway 69 other than a part described in subdivision (4).
(2) The addition of toll lanes, including high occupancy toll lanes, to a highway, roadway, or other facility in existence on July 1, 2011, if the number of nontolled lanes on the highway, roadway, or facility as of July 1, 2011, does not decrease due to the addition of the toll lanes.
(3) The Illiana Expressway, a limited access facility connecting Interstate Highway 65 in northwestern Indiana with an interstate highway in Illinois.
(4) A project that is located within a metropolitan planning area (as defined by 23 U.S.C. 134) and that connects the state of Indiana with the commonwealth of Kentucky.
(c) Before the authority or an operator may carry out any of the
following activities under this article, the general assembly must enact
a statute authorizing that activity:
(1) Carrying out construction for Interstate Highway 69 in a
township having a population of more than seventy-five one
hundred thousand (75,000) (100,000) and less than ninety-three
one hundred ten thousand five hundred (93,500). (110,000)
located in a county having a consolidated city.
(2) Imposing tolls on motor vehicles for use of Interstate Highway
69.
(3) Imposing tolls on motor vehicles for use of a nontolled
highway, roadway, or other facility in existence or under
construction on July 1, 2011, including nontolled interstate
highways, U.S. routes, and state routes.
(b) Notwithstanding any other law, before the department, the authority, or an operator may carry out any of the following activities under this article, the general assembly must enact a statute authorizing that activity:
(1) Subject to subsection (d), and after June 30, 2011, issuing a request for proposals for, or entering into, a public-private agreement concerning a project.
(2) Carrying out construction for Interstate Highway 69 in a township having a population of more than
(3) Imposing user fees on motor vehicles for use of Interstate Highway 69.
(c) Notwithstanding subsection (b) or any other law, the department or the authority may enter into a public-private agreement concerning a project consisting of a passenger or freight railroad system described in IC 8-15.7-2-14(a)(4). Such an agreement is subject to review and appropriation by the general assembly. However, this subsection does
not prohibit the department from:
(1) conducting preliminary studies that the department considers
necessary to determine the feasibility of such a project; or
(2) issuing a request for qualifications or a request for proposals,
or both, under IC 8-15.7-4 for such a project.
(d) Notwithstanding subsection (b), during the period beginning
July 1, 2011, and ending June 30, 2021, the general assembly is not
required to enact a statute authorizing the department, the authority, or
an operator to issue a request for proposals for, or enter into, a
public-private agreement for the following projects:
(1) A project on which construction begins after June 30, 2011,
not including any part of Interstate Highway 69 other than a part
described in subdivision (4).
(2) The addition of toll lanes, including high occupancy toll lanes,
to a highway, roadway, or other facility in existence on July 1,
2011, if the number of nontolled lanes on the highway, roadway,
or facility as of July 1, 2011, does not decrease due to the addition
of the toll lanes.
(3) The Illiana Expressway, a limited access facility connecting
Interstate Highway 65 in northwestern Indiana with an interstate
highway in Illinois.
(4) A project that is located within a metropolitan planning area
(as defined by 23 U.S.C. 134) and that connects the state of
Indiana with the commonwealth of Kentucky.
(1) a population of more than one hundred thousand (100,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); and
(2) a major obstruction between commercial or population centers which is capable of causing an economic hardship because of excess travel required to conduct a normal level of commerce between the two (2) centers.
A major obstruction which is a part of a county boundary or a state boundary does not qualify for the purpose of this chapter.
(b) As used in this chapter, "major bridge" means the following:
(1) A structure that is two hundred (200) or more feet in length and that is erected over a depression or an obstruction for the purpose of carrying motor vehicular traffic or other moving loads. However, the structure shall be one hundred (100) or more feet in length in a city having
(A) More than
(B) More than
(C) More than
(2) An underpass of any length that is designed to carry motor vehicle traffic or other moving loads.
(c) As used in this chapter, "major obstruction" means a physical barrier to the passage of motor vehicle traffic that inhibits the use of the customary highway construction techniques to bridge the barrier without use of a grade separation structure.
(b) The following apply to a board of aviation commissioners established under this chapter:
(1) Except as provided in subsections (e), (f), and (g), the board consists of four (4) members.
(2) Except as provided in subsection (e), the executive of the entity shall appoint the members of the board.
(3) Except as provided in subsections (f) and (g), not more than two (2) of the members of the board may be of the same political party.
(c) The fiscal body of the entity may provide a per diem for the members of the board in any amount not exceeding thirty-five dollars ($35) for each whole or part day a member is engaged in board activities. The members of the board shall also be paid their actual expenses, which may include the expenses of the members or employees of the board in attending meetings or conventions held to discuss aviation matters.
(d) Before beginning the duties of office, each board member shall take and subscribe the usual oath of office, to be endorsed upon the
certificate of appointment, and shall cause that to be filed with the clerk
or other officer performing duties similar to that of clerk in the entity.
Any person who does not file the oath with the clerk or other officer
performing duties similar to that of the clerk within thirty (30) days
after the beginning of the term for which the person has been
appointed, or at the date of the person's appointment, if appointed after
the beginning of the term, is considered to have refused to serve and
the office becomes vacant.
(e) Notwithstanding subsection (b), if a county having a population
of more than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less
than three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000) (270,000) has
established a board, the county council and the mayors of the two (2)
cities in the county having the largest populations may each appoint
one (1) additional member to the board, thereby creating a board
consisting of a total of seven (7) members. The three (3) additional
members serve in the same manner, are accorded the same status, and
perform the same duties as the four (4) initial board members, and
serve terms of four (4) years. If either the county council or either of
the two (2) mayors fails to make appointments to the board, that fact
does not prejudice appointments that may be made by the other
appointing authority or authorities.
(f) This subsection applies to the following:
(1) A county having a population of more than ninety one
hundred ten thousand (90,000) (110,000) but less than one
hundred eleven thousand (100,000). (111,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than thirty-six
thirty-seven thousand (36,000) five hundred (37,500) but less
than thirty-six thirty-eight thousand seventy-five (36,075).
(38,000).
Notwithstanding subsection (b), if a county has established a board
under this chapter, the county executive may add one (1) additional
member to the board so that the board has a total of five (5) members.
Not more than three (3) of the five (5) members of the board may be of
the same political party. The one (1) additional member shall serve in
the same manner, be accorded the same status, and perform the same
duties as the four (4) initial members, and serve a four (4) year term.
(g) This subsection does not apply to a board subject to subsection
(e) or (f). Notwithstanding subsection (b), the fiscal body of an eligible
entity may adopt an ordinance or a resolution providing that the board
consists of five (5) members. If the board consists of five (5) members,
not more than three (3) members may be of the same political party.
FOLLOWS [EFFECTIVE APRIL 1, 2012]: Sec. 1.1. (a)
Notwithstanding section 1 of this chapter, an airport authority is
established in a Allen County. having a population of more than three
hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand
(400,000).
(b) For the purposes of this chapter, an authority established under
this section shall be treated as if it had been established by an
ordinance of the fiscal body of the county. However, section 2 of this
chapter does not apply to such an authority.
(c) The name of an authority established under this section is
"(name of second class city)-(name of county) the "Fort Wayne-Allen
County Airport Authority".
(b) In the event that two (2) cities or one (1) city and one (1) town act jointly to establish an authority under this chapter, the board consists of five (5) members. The executive of each city or town shall each appoint two (2) members to the board. The county executive shall appoint one (1) member to the board. Each member appointed by an executive must be of a different political party than the other appointed member.
(c) In the event that an authority is established by a city or town and a county, acting jointly, the board consists of six (6) members. The executive of each entity shall appoint three (3) members. Not more than two (2) members appointed by each executive may be of the same political party.
(d) In the event that an authority was established under IC 19-6-3 (before its repeal on April 1, 1980) the board consists of five (5) members. Three (3) members of the board shall be appointed by the mayor of the city, and two (2) members of the board shall be appointed by the board of commissioners of the county. Not more than two (2) members representing the city may be members of the same political party, and not more than one (1) member representing the county may be a member of the same political party.
(e) Except as provided in section 4.1(b)(3) of this chapter, the county executive of each Indiana county that is adjacent to a county
establishing an authority under this chapter and in which the authority
owns real property may appoint one (1) advisory member to the board.
An advisory member who is appointed under this subsection:
(1) must be a resident of the adjacent county;
(2) may not vote on any matter before the board;
(3) serves at the pleasure of the appointing authority; and
(4) serves without compensation or payment for expenses.
(f) The board of an authority established in a city that has having a
population of more than sixteen thousand six four hundred (16,600)
(16,400) but less than seventeen thousand four hundred (17,400)
(17,000) consists of five (5) members. The members of the board shall
be appointed by the executive of the eligible entity, and not more than
three (3) members of the board may be of the same political party.
(g) This subsection does not apply to a board subject to subsection
(b), (c), (d), or (f). Notwithstanding subsection (a), the fiscal body of
an eligible entity may adopt an ordinance or a resolution providing that
the board consists of five (5) members. If the board consists of five (5)
members, not more than three (3) members may be of the same
political party.
(b) The board consists of members appointed as follows:
(1) The mayor of the consolidated city shall appoint five (5) members. Each member appointed under this subdivision must be a resident of the county having the consolidated city.
(2) The majority leader of the legislative body of the county having the consolidated city shall appoint one (1) member. The member appointed under this subdivision must be a resident of the county having the consolidated city.
(3) The county executive of each Indiana county that fulfills all of the following requirements shall each appoint one (1) member:
(A) The county is adjacent to the county having the consolidated city.
(B) The county has a population of:
(i) more than one hundred forty thousand
(ii) more than
(iii) more than
(C) The authority owns real property in the county.
The county executive of a county represented on the board under this subdivision may not appoint an advisory member under section 4(e) of this chapter.
Not more than three (3) members appointed under subdivision (1) may be members of the same political party.
(c) The member of the board appointed under subsection (b)(2) must also be a resident of a township that:
(1) is located in the county having the consolidated city; and
(2) has a population of:
(A) less than
(B) more than one hundred thirty-three thousand (133,000) but less than one hundred
(d) A member of the board appointed under subsection (b)(3)(B)(i) must be a resident of a township:
(1) located in the county making the appointment; and
(2) having a population of more than
(e) The county executive of a county that is not otherwise represented on the board and that is located not more than one thousand two hundred (1,200) feet from a certified air carrier airport that is owned or operated by the authority may appoint one (1) advisory member to the board. An advisory member appointed under this subsection:
(1) must be a resident of:
(A) the county making the appointment; and
(B) one (1) of the two (2) townships in the county located nearest to the airport;
(2) may not vote on any matter before the board;
(3) serves at the pleasure of the appointing authority; and
(4) serves without compensation or payment for expenses.
(f) A member of the board holds office for four (4) years and until the member's successor is appointed and qualified.
(g) If a vacancy occurs in the board, the authority that appointed the member that vacated the board shall appoint an individual to serve for the remainder of the unexpired term.
(h) A board member may be reappointed to successive terms.
(i) A board member may be impeached under the procedure provided for the impeachment of county officers.
(j) A board member appointed under subsection (b)(3) may not vote on a matter before the board relating to imposing, increasing, or decreasing property taxes in the county having the consolidated city.
(1) Each county having a consolidated city.
(2) Each city having a population of more than
(3) Each county having a population of more than one hundred five thousand (105,000) but less than one hundred ten thousand (110,000).
(4) Each county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000).
(5) Each county having a population of more than one hundred
(6) Each county having a population of more than one hundred
(7) Each city having a population of more than
(1) city having a population of more than
(2) county having a population of more than one hundred five thousand (105,000) but less than one hundred ten thousand (110,000); or
(3) county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000);
may enter into a lease of an airport project with a lessor for a term not to exceed fifty (50) years and the lease may provide for payments to be made by the airport authority from property taxes levied under IC 8-22-3-17, taxes allocated under IC 8-22-3.5-9, any other revenues available to the airport authority, or any combination of these sources.
(b) A lease may provide that payments by the authority to the lessor are required only to the extent and only for the period that the lessor is able to provide the leased facilities in accordance with the lease. The terms of each lease must be based upon the value of the facilities leased and may not create a debt of the authority or the eligible entity for purposes of the Constitution of the State of Indiana.
(c) A lease may be entered into by the authority only after a public hearing by the board at which all interested parties are provided the opportunity to be heard. After the public hearing, the board may adopt an ordinance authorizing the execution of the lease if it finds that the service to be provided throughout the term of the lease will serve the public purpose of the authority and is in the best interest of the residents of the authority district.
(d) Upon execution of a lease providing for payments by the authority in whole or in part from the levy of property taxes under IC 8-22-3-17, the board shall publish notice of the execution of the lease and its approval in accordance with IC 5-3-1. Fifty (50) or more taxpayers residing in the authority district who will be affected by the lease and who may be of the opinion that no necessity exists for the execution of the lease or that the payments provided for in the lease are not fair and reasonable may file a petition in the office of the county auditor within thirty (30) days after the publication of the notice of execution and approval. The petition must set forth the petitioners' names, addresses, and objections to the lease and the facts showing that the execution of the lease is unnecessary or unwise or that the payments provided for in the lease are not fair and reasonable, as the case may be.
(e) Upon the filing of a petition under subsection (d), the county auditor shall immediately certify a copy of the petition, together with any other data necessary to present the questions involved, to the department of local government finance. Upon receipt of the certified petition and information, the department of local government finance shall fix a time and place for a hearing in the authority district, which must be not less than five (5) or more than thirty (30) days after the time is fixed. Notice of the hearing shall be given by the department of local government finance to the members of the board, and to the first fifty (50) petitioners on the petition, by a letter signed by the
commissioner of the department of local government finance and
enclosed with fully prepaid postage sent to those persons at their usual
place of residence, at least five (5) days before the date of the hearing.
The decision of the department of local government finance or on the
appeal, upon the necessity for the execution of the lease, and as to
whether the payments under it are fair and reasonable, is final.
(f) An authority entering into a lease payable from any sources
permitted under this chapter may:
(1) pledge the revenue to make payments under the lease pursuant
to IC 5-1-14-4; or
(2) establish a special fund to make the payments.
(g) Lease rentals may be limited to money in the special fund so that
the obligations of the airport authority to make the lease rental
payments are not considered debt of the unit or the district for purposes
of the Constitution of the State of Indiana.
(h) Except as provided in this section, no approvals of any
governmental body or agency are required before the authority enters
into a lease under this section.
(i) An action to contest the validity of the lease or to enjoin the
performance of any of its terms and conditions must be brought within
thirty (30) days after the later of:
(1) the public hearing described in subsection (c); or
(2) the publication of the notice of the execution and approval of
the lease described in subsection (d), if the lease is payable in
whole or in part from tax levies.
However, if the lease is payable in whole or in part from tax levies and
an appeal has been taken to the department of local government
finance, an action to contest the validity or enjoin the performance
must be brought within thirty (30) days after the decision of the
department of local government finance.
(j) If an authority exercises an option to buy an airport project from
a lessor, the authority may subsequently sell the airport project, without
regard to any other statute, to the lessor at the end of the lease term at
a price set forth in the lease or at fair market value established at the
time of the sale by the authority through auction, appraisal, or arms
length negotiation. If the airport project is sold at auction, after
appraisal, or through negotiation, the board shall conduct a hearing
after public notice in accordance with IC 5-3-1 before the sale. Any
action to contest the sale must be brought within fifteen (15) days of
the hearing.
IC 8-22-1-6, as used in this chapter, "eligible entity" means the
following:
(1) A city having a population of more than ninety eighty
thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five eighty
thousand (105,000). four hundred (80,400).
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred five
thousand (105,000) but less than one hundred ten thousand
(110,000).
(3) A county having a population of more than three hundred
thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand
(400,000).
(b) A person who drives a motor vehicle equipped with compression release engine brakes on the Indiana toll road in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(1) be accompanied by the fee required under IC 9-29-8;
(2) be on a form prescribed by the secretary of state;
(3) contain the information the secretary of state considers necessary to enable the secretary of state to determine fully the following information:
(A) The qualifications and eligibility of the applicant to receive the license.
(B) The location of each of the applicant's places of business in Indiana.
(C) The ability of the applicant to conduct properly the business for which the application is submitted; and
(4) contain evidence of a bond required in subsection (e).
(b) An application for a license as a dealer must show whether the applicant proposes to sell new or used motor vehicles, or both.
(c) An applicant who proposes to use the Internet or other computer
network in aid of its sale of motor vehicles to consumers in Indiana,
which activities may result in the creation of business records outside
Indiana, shall provide the division with the name, address, and
telephone number of the person who has control of those business
records. The secretary of state may not issue a license to a dealer who
transacts business in this manner who does not have an established
place of business in Indiana.
(d) This subsection applies to an application for a license as a dealer
in a city having a population of more than ninety eighty thousand
(90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five eighty thousand
(105,000). four hundred (80,400). The application must include an
affidavit from:
(1) the person charged with enforcing a zoning ordinance
described in this subsection; or
(2) the zoning enforcement officer under IC 36-7-4, if one exists;
who has jurisdiction over the real property where the applicant wants
to operate as a dealer. The affidavit must state that the proposed
location is zoned for the operation of a dealer's establishment. The
applicant may file the affidavit at any time after the filing of the
application. However, the secretary of state may not issue a license
until the applicant files the affidavit.
(e) This subsection does not apply to a person listed in the
categories set forth in section 1(a)(10) through 1(a)(12) of this chapter
and that was licensed under this chapter before July 1, 2009. A licensee
shall maintain a bond satisfactory to the secretary of state in the amount
of twenty-five thousand dollars ($25,000), which must:
(1) be in favor of the state; and
(2) secure payment of fines, penalties, costs, and fees assessed by
the secretary of state after notice, opportunity for a hearing, and
opportunity for judicial review, in addition to securing the
payment of damages to a person aggrieved by a violation of this
chapter by the licensee after a judgment has been issued.
(f) Service shall be made in accordance with the Indiana Rules of
Trial Procedure.
(g) Instead of meeting the requirement in subsection (e), a licensee
may submit to the secretary of state evidence that the licensee is a
member of a risk retention group regulated by the Indiana department
of insurance.
dealer under this chapter must specify the location of each place of
business and shall be conspicuously displayed at each business
location.
(b) If a business name or location is changed, the holder shall notify
the secretary of state within ten (10) days and remit the fee required
under IC 9-29-8. The secretary of state shall endorse that change on the
license if the secretary of state determines that the change is not subject
to other provisions of this article.
(c) A dealer who uses the Internet or other computer network to
facilitate the sale of motor vehicles as set forth in section 2(c) of this
chapter shall notify the secretary of state within ten (10) days upon any
change in the name, address, or telephone number of business records
located outside Indiana that have been created in transactions made in
Indiana by the dealer. A report made under this subsection is not
subject to the fee required under IC 9-29-8-5.
(d) This subsection applies to a dealer in a city having a population
of more than ninety eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than
one hundred five eighty thousand (105,000). four hundred (80,400).
A dealer who wants to change a location must submit to the secretary
of state an application for approval of the change. The application must
be accompanied by an affidavit from:
(1) the person charged with enforcing a zoning ordinance
described in this subsection; or
(2) the zoning enforcement officer under IC 36-7-4, if one exists;
who has jurisdiction over the real property where the applicant wants
to operate as a dealer. The affidavit must state that the proposed
location is zoned for the operation of a dealer's establishment. The
secretary of state may not approve a change of location or endorse a
change of location on the dealer's license until the dealer provides the
affidavit.
(e) For the purpose of this section, an offsite license issued under
section 7 of this chapter does not constitute a change of location.
(b) Except as provided in subsections (e) through (f), from the information described in subsection (a), the commissioner shall
prescribe, subject to approval by the state personnel department and the
budget agency, a salary schedule for each correctional institution, using
a daily rate of pay for each teacher, which must be equal to that of the
largest school corporation in the county in which the correctional
institution is located.
(c) The commissioner shall prescribe the terms of the annual
contract awarded to licensed teachers qualifying for payment under the
schedule established under subsection (b).
(d) Hours of work for all teachers shall be set in accordance with
IC 4-15-2 (repealed).
(e) If the school corporation in which the correctional institution is
located becomes the largest school corporation in the county in which
the correctional institution is located, the daily rate of pay for each
teacher must be equal to that of the school corporation in which the
correctional institution is located without regard to whether the school
corporation in which the correctional institution is located remains the
largest school corporation in the county.
(f) Using a daily rate of pay for each teacher, the salary schedule for
each correctional institution located in a county having a population of:
(1) more than seventeen thousand (17,000) two hundred fifty
(17,250) but less than seventeen thousand five three hundred
(17,500); fifty (17,350); or
(2) more than one hundred forty thousand (100,000) (140,000)
but less than one hundred five fifty thousand (105,000);
(150,000);
must be equal to that of the school corporation in which the
correctional institution is located.
Adams County
Allen County
Bartholomew County
Benton County
Blackford County
Boone County
Brown County
Carroll County
Cass County
Clark County
Clay County
Clinton County
Crawford County
Daviess County
Dearborn County
Decatur County
Dekalb County
Delaware County
Dubois County
Elkhart County
Fayette County
Floyd County
Fountain County
Franklin County
Fulton County
Gibson County
Grant County
Greene County
Hamilton County
Hancock County
Harrison County
Hendricks County
Henry County
Howard County
Huntington County
Jackson County
Jasper County
Jay County
Jefferson County
Jennings County
Johnson County
Knox County
Kosciusko County
LaGrange County
Lake County
LaPorte County
Lawrence County
Madison County
Marion County
Marshall County
Martin County
Miami County
Monroe County
Montgomery County
Morgan County
Newton County
Noble County
Ohio County
Orange County
Owen County
Parke County
Perry County
Pike County
Porter County
Posey County
Pulaski County
Putnam County
Randolph County
Ripley County
Rush County
St. Joseph County
Scott County
Shelby County
Spencer County
Starke County
Steuben County
Sullivan County
Switzerland County
Tippecanoe County
Tipton County
Union County
Vanderburgh County
Vermillion County
Vigo County
Wabash County
Warren County
Warrick County
Washington County
Wayne County
Wells County
White County
Whitley County
(b) The multiplier under this chapter for each county, which represents each county's approximate proportion of the total state
population, is as follows:
Adams County
Allen County
Bartholomew County
Benton County
Blackford County
Boone County
Brown County
Carroll County
Cass County
Clark County
Clay County
Clinton County
Crawford County
Daviess County
Dearborn County
Decatur County
Dekalb County
Delaware County
Dubois County
Elkhart County
Fayette County
Floyd County
Fountain County
Franklin County
Fulton County
Gibson County
Grant County
Greene County
Hamilton County
Hancock County
Harrison County
Hendricks County
Henry County
Howard County
Huntington County
Jackson County
Jasper County
Jay County
Jefferson County
Jennings County
Johnson County
Knox County
Kosciusko County
LaGrange County
Lake County
LaPorte County
Lawrence County
Madison County
Marion County
Marshall County
Martin County
Miami County
Monroe County
Montgomery County
Morgan County
Newton County
Noble County
Ohio County
Orange County
Owen County
Parke County
Perry County
Pike County
Porter County
Posey County
Pulaski County
Putnam County
Randolph County
Ripley County
Rush County
St. Joseph County
Scott County
Shelby County
Spencer County
Starke County
Steuben County
Sullivan County
Switzerland County
Tippecanoe County
Tipton County
Union County
Vanderburgh County
Vermillion County
Vigo County
Wabash County
Warren County
Warrick County
Washington County
Wayne County
Wells County
White County
Whitley County
(1) who is determined by the office to be eligible for enrollment in a Medicaid managed care program;
(2) whose Medicaid eligibility is not based on the individual's aged, blind, or disabled status; and
(3) who resides in a county having a population of:
(A) more than one hundred
(B) more than one hundred
(C) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(D) more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000); or
(E) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(b) Not later than January 1, 2003, the office shall require a recipient described in subsection (a) to enroll in the risk-based managed care program.
(c) The office:
(1) shall apply to the United States Department of Health and Human Services for any approval necessary; and
(2) may adopt rules under IC 4-22-2;
to implement this section.
thirty-six thousand (46,000). eight hundred twenty-five (36,825).
(1) The county has a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000).
(2) The county maintains, owns, or maintains and owns a county home for the support and care of persons who are aged, blind, destitute, homeless, infirm, chronically ill, or in need of nursing or convalescent care, but who do not require hospitalization.
(3) The county maintains, owns, or maintains and owns a hospital for the treatment of patients afflicted with tuberculosis and other chronic diseases that contracts with other counties for the treatment of citizens of the other counties.
(b) This chapter applies to a county that meets the following conditions:
(1) The county has a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(2) The county maintains or owns a county home for the support and care of persons who are aged, blind, destitute, homeless, infirm, chronically ill, or in need of nursing or convalescent care, but who do not require hospitalization.
(1) A county having a population of more than
(2) A county having a population of more than
(b) For the purpose of determining the number of inspection stations operating in a county under this subsection, a temporary or portable inspection station counts as an inspection station. After July 1, 1997, the department must maintain in a county under subsection (a) an equal or greater number of inspection stations as were operating in the county on July 1, 1996.
laws that requires motor vehicles to undergo a periodic test of emission
characteristics in the following counties:
(1) A county having a population of more than seventy
seventy-one thousand (70,000) (71,000) but less than seventy-one
seventy-five thousand (71,000). (75,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than ninety one
hundred ten thousand (90,000) (110,000) but less than one
hundred eleven thousand (100,000). (111,000).
(b) After December 31, 2006, 326 IAC 13-1.1 is void to the extent
it applies to a county referred to in subsection (a).
(c) Unless the budget agency approves a periodic vehicle inspection
program for a county referred to in subsection (a), the board shall
amend 326 IAC 13-1.1 so that it does not apply after December 31,
2006, to a county referred to in subsection (a).
(d) The budget agency, after review by the budget committee, may
approve in writing the implementation of a periodic vehicle inspection
program for one (1) or more counties described in subsection (a) only
if the budget agency determines that the implementation of a periodic
vehicle inspection program in the designated counties is necessary to
avoid a loss of federal highway funding for the state or a political
subdivision. The approval must specify the counties to which the
periodic vehicle inspection program applies and the time during which
the periodic vehicle inspection program must be conducted in each
designated county. The budget agency, after review by the budget
committee, shall withdraw an approval given under this subsection for
a periodic vehicle inspection program in a county if the budget agency
determines that the suspension of the periodic vehicle inspection
program will not adversely affect federal highway funding for the state
or a political subdivision.
(1) has a population of:
(A) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(B) more than one hundred
(2) is located in an air quality control area that has been classified
as a nonattainment area under the federal Clean Air Act (42
U.S.C. 7401 et seq.);
unless it can be demonstrated that the thermal oxidation unit is in
compliance with a state implementation plan submitted under Section
182 of the federal Clean Air Act (42 U.S.C. 7511a).
(1) Two (2) members appointed by the county executive from the membership of the county executive.
(2) One (1) member appointed by the county fiscal body from the membership of the fiscal body.
(3) One (1) member:
(A) who is the executive of the municipality having the largest population in the county if that municipality is a city; or
(B) appointed from the membership of the legislative body of a town if the town is the municipality having the largest population in the county.
(4) One (1) member of the legislative body of the municipality with the largest population in the county appointed by the legislative body of that municipality.
(5) One (1) member:
(A) who is the executive of a city in the county that is not the municipality having the largest population in the county; or
(B) who is a member of the legislative body of a town that is not the municipality having the largest population in the county;
and who is appointed by the executive of that county to represent the municipalities in the county other than the municipality having the largest population.
(6) One (1) additional member appointed by the county executive from the membership of the county executive.
(b) If a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000) is designated as a county district, the executives of the three (3) cities in
the county having the largest populations each serve as a member of
the board or may appoint a member of the legislative body of their city
to serve as a member of the board. If a county having a population of
more than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less
than three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000) (270,000) is
designated as a county district, the executives of the two (2) cities in
the county having the largest populations each serve as a member of
the board. If a county having a population of more than two hundred
fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two hundred
seventy thousand (300,000) (270,000) is designated as a county
district, the board of that county district must include the following:
(1) One (1) member of the legislative body of the city having the
second largest population in the county, appointed by the
president of the city legislative body.
(2) One (1) member of the legislative body of a town located in
the county, appointed by the judge of the circuit court in the
county.
(c) If a county having a consolidated city is designated a county
district, the board of public works established under IC 36-3-5-6
constitutes the board of the county district.
(d) If a county designated as a county district has a population of
more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven
hundred thousand (700,000), the board of the district consists of the
following members:
(1) One (1) member appointed by the county executive from the
membership of the county executive.
(2) Two (2) members appointed from the county fiscal body
appointed from the membership of the county fiscal body.
(3) The executive of each second or third class city or a member
of the legislative body of their city appointed by the executive.
(4) One (1) member of the legislative body of each town
appointed by the legislative body.
(5) One (1) member of the legislative body of the municipality
with the largest population in the county appointed by the
legislative body of that municipality.
(6) If a local government unit in the county has an operating final
disposal facility located within the unit's jurisdiction, one (1)
member of the unit's board of public works appointed by the
board of public works.
(e) This subsection applies only to a county that does not contain a
city. If the county executive and the county fiscal body of a county
designated as a county district agree, the board of the district shall
consist of the following nine (9) or ten (10) members:
(1) The three (3) members of the county executive.
(2) Two (2) members of the county fiscal body, chosen by the
county fiscal body.
(3) One (1) member of each of the town legislative bodies of the
four (4) or five (5) towns in the county having the largest
population, chosen by each town legislative body.
(1) One (1) member of the county executive of each participating county.
(2) One (1) member of the county fiscal body of each participating county.
(3) One (1) member:
(A) who is the executive of the municipality having the largest population in the county if that municipality is a city; or
(B) if a town is the municipality having the largest population in the county, who is appointed from the membership of the fiscal body of that town.
(4) One (1) member of the legislative body of the municipality having the largest population in each participating county, appointed by the legislative body of that municipality.
(5) One (1) or more members who are the executives of cities under subsection (b), if applicable.
(6) Additional members appointed by the executive of each participating county from the membership of the executive, as permitted under subsection (c).
(7) One (1) additional member appointed by the executive of the participating county having the largest population from the membership of the executive if the appointments made under subdivisions (1) through (6) result in an even number of members.
(b) If a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000) has joined in a joint district, the executive of the three (3) cities in the county having the largest populations each serve as a member of the board. If a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
populations each serve as a member of the board.
(c) An agreement between two (2) or more counties establishing a
joint district may allow the executive of each county to appoint a
certain number of additional members from the membership of the
executive based upon the proportion of each county's population to the
population of the entire district.
(d) An agreement among three (3) or more counties establishing a
joint district may provide that:
(1) the membership; and
(2) the terms of office of members;
of the board will be determined by the terms of an agreement entered
into by the executive of each county governing the operation of the
district. All members of a board appointed under this subsection must
be elected officials of a county or a municipality.
(e) The board of a joint district established under subsection (d) or
IC 13-9.5-2-6(d) (before its repeal) after March 1, 1991:
(1) must include representation from the largest municipality in
each county included in the joint district as recommended by the
executive of the largest municipality and approved by the
legislative body of the largest municipality; and
(2) may include representation from other municipalities in each
county included in the joint district as recommended by the
executive of a municipality and approved by the legislative body
of the municipality.
(f) The board of a joint district may allow a member who is
appointed from:
(1) the county executive;
(2) a county fiscal body; or
(3) a municipal legislative body;
to have the body on which the member serves designate an alternate
member from that body to participate and exercise the right to vote
with the board if the member is unable to attend a meeting.
(b) In addition to the powers granted to a district under section 12 of this chapter, a district may make grants or loans of money, property, or services to a public or private program to plant or maintain trees in an area of the district that is a right-of-way, public property, or vacant property.
(1) The continuation of waste management services that a solid waste district provides with its facilities or work force before March 15, 1996.
(2) Waste management services provided to the district under an agreement entered into by the district before March 15, 1996, with another person until the agreement terminates by its terms or is terminated for cause.
(3) The development, operation, and contracting for the development or operation of a publicly owned solid waste landfill in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(4) A contract entered into between the board and a third party before May 1, 1997, for the development or operation of a solid waste landfill in a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000). The third party is limited to those parties that submitted proposals to the board under a formal request for proposals that were selected by the board, before December 1, 1995, as finalists in the contract negotiations.
(5) A contract between a board and a third party to operate a facility that is owned by the district and for which construction was substantially complete before March 1, 1996.
(6) Activities conducted as part of household hazardous waste (as defined in IC 13-11-2-104) collection and disposal projects.
(7) A contract executed before April 1, 1998.
(b) Except as provided in subsection (c), a district may not:
(1) undertake to provide waste management services by means of its own work force; or
(2) contract with any person to provide waste management services.
(c) A district may perform the activities described in subsection (b):
(1) if:
(A) the board is able to adopt a resolution under subsection (d); and
(B) a private sector entity is not willing or able to provide waste management services at a reasonable cost to the district;
or
(2) if the district is requested to do so by a unit of government that
performs the activities with the unit's work force.
(d) The board may adopt a resolution determining that the district
must either provide waste management services by means of its own
work force or contract with a person to provide waste management
services, only if the board finds that:
(1) the waste management service is not currently available in the
district at a reasonable cost; and
(2) providing the waste management service by means of its own
work force or by contract will benefit the public health, welfare,
and safety of residents of the district.
The board's determination must be supported with findings of fact.
(e) A district shall provide notice by publication under IC 5-3-1 and
at the time of publication serve by first class mail to any person that
delivers to the district an annual written request for notices before
January 1 of any meeting to consider adoption of a resolution making
a preliminary determination that it is necessary for the district to
undertake to provide waste management services by means of its own
work force or contract with any person to provide waste management
services.
(f) Whenever a district evaluates the reasonableness of cost under
this section, it shall:
(1) compare the cost of the same level of service provided in the
district or in similar demographic areas within Indiana; and
(2) if the district wishes to provide waste management services
with its own facilities or work force, the district must disclose the
entire cost of providing the service by the district, including the
following:
(A) Subsidies arising from taxes, fees, grants, or
intergovernmental transfers.
(B) In-kind contributions of real estate, interests in real estate,
equipment, personnel, or other assets.
(C) Discounts.
(D) Tax exemptions.
(g) A resolution adopted under subsection (d) may authorize a
district to perform more than one (1) solid waste recycling, collection,
or disposal event in the manner described in subsection (b) if:
(1) the duration of each event authorized by the resolution is not
more than one (1) day; and
(2) all events authorized by the resolution will take place in one
(1) calendar year.
(1) The district is in the process of constructing a landfill.
(2) A higher property tax rate is necessary to pay the fees charged by out of county landfills to dispose of solid waste generated in the district during the design and construction phases of the landfill being established by the district.
(b) The procedure applicable to maximum levy appeals under IC 6-1.1-18.5 applies to an appeal under this section. Any additional levy granted under this section may not exceed seven and thirty-three hundredths cents ($0.0733) on each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed valuation of property in the district.
(c) The department of local government finance shall establish the tax rate if a higher tax rate is permitted.
(d) A property tax rate imposed under this section expires not later than December 31, 1997.
(1) two dollars and fifty cents ($2.50) a ton; or
(2) the amount of a fee imposed by the board;
(A) under this section; and
(B) in effect on January 1, 1993;
whichever is greater.
(b) The board shall do the following:
(1) Set the amount of fees imposed under this section after a public hearing.
(2) Give public notice of the hearing.
(c) If solid waste has been subject to a district fee under this section,
the total amount of the fee that was paid shall be credited against a
district fee to which the solid waste may later be subject under this
section.
(d) Except as provided in section 4 of this chapter, fees imposed
under this chapter shall be imposed uniformly on public facilities and
on privately owned or operated facilities throughout the district.
(e) A resolution adopted by a board that establishes fees under this
chapter may contain a provision that authorizes the board to impose a
penalty of not more than five hundred dollars ($500) per day because
of:
(1) nonpayment of fees; or
(2) noncompliance with a condition in the resolution.
(f) A board may not impose fees for material used as alternate daily
cover pursuant to a permit issued by the department under 329
IAC 10-20-13.
(b) Except as provided in subsection (c), a person operating a motorboat may not approach or pass within two hundred (200) feet of the shore line of a lake or channel of the lake at a speed greater than idle speed.
(c) This subsection applies to lakes formed by hydroelectric dams in a county having a population of:
(1) more than
(2) more than twenty thousand (20,000) but less than twenty thousand
A person operating a motorboat may not approach or pass within fifty (50) feet of the shore line at a speed greater than idle speed. However, on tributaries of lakes described in this subsection that are formed by hydroelectric dams, a person operating a motor boat may not approach or pass within two hundred (200) feet of the shore line of the tributary at a speed greater than idle speed. For the purposes of this chapter, tributaries on lakes formed by hydroelectric dams do not include the principal body of water flowing into the lakes.
(1) An artificial lake that is created or used in or in connection with the following:
(A) Supplying a city or town with water.
(B) The generation of electric energy.
(C) The storage of water for a use described in clause (A) or (B).
(2) The waters of Lake Michigan.
(3) A lake owned or controlled by the department.
(4) The waters of an artificial lake in a town located in a county having a population of more than
(1) A city having a population of more than one hundred
(2) The county in which a city described in subdivision (1) exists.
(b) If the court determines that a petition conforms to the requirements, the court shall enter an order referring the petition to the commission.
(c) The commission shall make a determination and report to the court whether the proposed district should be established after determining whether the proposed district meets the following conditions:
(1) The proposed district appears to be necessary.
(2) The proposed district holds promise of economic and engineering feasibility.
(3) The proposed district seems to offer benefits in excess of costs and damages for purposes other than the following:
(A) Water supply.
(B) Storage of water for augmentation of stream flow.
(C) Sewage disposal.
(4) Whether the public health will be served immediately or prospectively by the establishment of the district for any of the following purposes:
(A) Water supply.
(B) Sewage disposal.
(C) Storage of water for augmentation of stream flow.
(D) Any combination of these purposes.
(5) The proposed district proposes to cover and serve a proper area.
(6) The proposed district can be established and operated in a manner compatible with established:
(A) districts;
(B) flood control projects;
(C) reservoirs;
(D) lakes;
(E) drains;
(F) levees;
(G) regional water districts;
(H) regional sewer districts; and
(I) other water management or water supply projects.
(d) The fact that all the land included in the proposed district is owned by one (1) freeholder or a limited number of freeholders is not a sufficient reason for the commission or the court to make unfavorable findings on:
(1) the question of the establishment of the district; and
(2) later, if the district is established, the approval of the district plan.
However, it must appear from the evidence that the land is subdivided or intended for subdivision and development and that the accomplishment of the purposes proposed and in the manner proposed would be necessary and desirable for the person acquiring and using the land after subdivision and development.
(b) This article governs conservancy districts located wholly within a county having a population of more than twenty-three thousand
(b) The executive of a county having a population of more than one hundred
(c) The county executive in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(d) A health ordinance adopted by a city legislative body after December 31, 1993, in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(1) was adopted after December 31, 1993, and before March 11, 1994; and
(2) applies to the entire county;
is legalized.
(1) A county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(3) A county having a population of more than
(b) Except as provided in subsection (c), the executive of each second class city shall appoint a number of members of the board in the proportion that the city's population is to the total county population to the nearest whole fraction. The appointments made under this subsection shall be made in order, according to the population of a city, with the city having the largest population making the first appointments. The county executive shall appoint the remaining number of members of the county board of health.
(c) The members of the local board of health in a county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000) shall be appointed as follows:
(1) Three (3) members shall be appointed by the executive of the most populous city in the county.
(2) Four (4) members shall be appointed by the county executive.
(b) Each year the county fiscal officer shall transfer to the community health clinic located in the county an amount equal to the revenue raised from a property tax rate of one hundred sixty-seven thousandths of one cent ($0.00167) for each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed valuation of the taxable property in the county.
(c) The transfer shall be made in four (4) equal installments before the end of January, April, July, and October. The transfer shall be made without the necessity of an appropriation.
(b) A local official, city legislative body, city fiscal body, or county may not establish a full-time or part-time city health department in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(c) A health ordinance adopted by a city legislative body after December 31, 1993, in a county having a population of more than one hundred
one hundred seventy seventy-five thousand (170,000) (175,000) is
void.
(1) was adopted after December 31, 1993, and before March 11, 1994; and
(2) applies to the entire county;
is legalized.
(1) More than
(2) More than
(b) Each year the fiscal officer of each city shall transfer to the community health clinic located in the county in which the city is located an amount equal to the revenue raised from a property tax rate of sixty-seven hundredths of one cent ($0.0067) for each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed valuation of the taxable property in the city.
(c) The transfer shall be made in four (4) equal installments before the end of January, April, July, and October. The transfer shall be made without the necessity of an appropriation.
(b) The management of a hospital is under the control of a governing board. The governing board consists of nine (9) members appointed by the county executive as follows:
(1) Three (3) members must be members of the county executive.
(2) Six (6) members meeting the following requirements:
(A) At least four (4) members must be residents of the county.
(B) Not more than two (2) members appointed under this subdivision may reside in a county other than the county in which the hospital is located. A member who is not a resident of the county in which the hospital is located must:
(i) be an Indiana resident; and
(ii) be appointed upon a submission made under section 11 of this chapter by the governing board of the hospital to the appointing authority.
(C) One (1) member appointed under this subdivision may also be a licensed physician.
(c) The term of each member of the governing board is three (3) years.
(d) If a vacancy occurs due to the expiration of an appointed member's term and the county executive does not fill the vacancy within sixty (60) days from the date of expiration, the member whose term has expired is automatically reappointed for another term.
(b) Subject to subsection (c), the governing board of a county hospital consists of seven (7) members, as follows:
(1) Three (3) members must be the members of the county executive.
(2) Four (4) members, one (1) of whom may be a licensed physician, shall be appointed by the judge of the circuit court of the county.
(c) Not more than two (2) members of a governing board appointed under this section may reside in a county other than the county in which the hospital is located. A member who is not a resident of the county in which the hospital is located must:
(1) be an Indiana resident; and
(2) be appointed upon a submission made under section 11 of this chapter by the governing board of the hospital to the appointing authority.
(d) The term of office for members of the governing board, other than the members of the county executive, is two (2) years.
(b) Subject to subsection (e), the hospital and the affairs and business of the hospital shall be under the management and control of a governing board consisting of seven (7) members as follows:
(1) Three (3) members must be members of the county executive.
(2) Two (2) members shall be appointed by the county fiscal body, one (1) of whom may be a licensed physician.
(3) Two (2) members shall be appointed by the county executive.
(c) One (1) of the members initially appointed by the county fiscal body serves for one (1) year and one (1) of the members initially appointed serves for two (2) years. After the initial appointment, the members serve for two (2) years.
(d) One (1) of the members initially appointed by the county executive serves for one (1) year and one (1) of the members initially appointed serves for two (2) years. After the initial appointment, the members serve for two (2) years.
(e) Not more than two (2) members of a governing board appointed under this section may reside in a county other than the county in which the hospital is located. A member who is not a resident of the county in which the hospital is located must:
(1) be an Indiana resident; and
(2) be appointed upon a submission made under section 11 of this chapter by the governing board of the hospital to the appointing authority.
(1) All members must be residents of the county in which the hospital is located except in the following circumstances:
(A) If a determination is made to increase a board size to five (5) or six (6) members, one (1) member may be a resident of
an Indiana county other than the county in which the hospital
is located if the member to be appointed was recommended by
the governing board as set forth in section 11 of this chapter to
fill the vacancy.
(B) If a determination is made to increase a board size to at
least seven (7) members, not more than two (2) members may
be residents of an Indiana county other than the county in
which the hospital is located if the member to be appointed
was recommended by the governing board as set forth in
section 11 of this chapter to fill the vacancy.
(2) If a board size of five (5) members is chosen, a new member
shall be appointed for an initial term of one (1) year.
(3) If a board size of six (6) members is chosen, the new members
shall be appointed in the following order as necessary:
(A) One (1) new member for an initial term of one (1) year.
(B) One (1) new member for an initial term of two (2) years.
(4) If a board size of seven (7) members is chosen, the new
members shall be appointed in the following order as necessary:
(A) One (1) new member for an initial term of one (1) year.
(B) One (1) new member for an initial term of two (2) years.
(C) One (1) new member for an initial term of three (3) years.
(5) If a board size of eight (8) members is chosen, the new
members shall be appointed in the following order as necessary:
(A) One (1) new member for an initial term of one (1) year.
(B) One (1) new member for an initial term of two (2) years.
(C) One (1) new member for an initial term of three (3) years.
(D) One (1) new member for an initial term of four (4) years.
(6) If a board size of nine (9) members is chosen, the new
members shall be appointed in the following order as necessary:
(A) Two (2) new members for an initial term of one (1) year.
(B) One (1) new member for an initial term of two (2) years.
(C) One (1) new member for an initial term of three (3) years.
(D) One (1) new member for an initial term of four (4) years.
(7) If a board size of seven (7), eight (8), or nine (9) members is
chosen, two (2) members may be licensed physicians.
(b) A governing board that has increased its size may petition the
county executive to decrease the size of the board. However, a decrease
under this subsection may only be accomplished through:
(1) the vacancy of a member's position, either through expiration
of the member's term or any other cause; or
(2) removal of a member as provided under applicable law.
(c) There is no limit to the number of times a governing board may
seek to increase or decrease its size under this section.
(d) For a governing board of four (4) members located in a county
having a population of:
(1) more than fourteen thousand five hundred (14,500) (14,000)
but less than fourteen fifteen thousand nine hundred (14,900);
(15,000);
(2) more than twenty-five twenty-four thousand (25,000) five
hundred (24,500) but less than twenty-five thousand five
hundred (25,500); (25,000); or
(3) more than thirty-three thousand eight two hundred (33,800)
(33,200) but less than thirty-four thirty-three thousand three two
hundred (34,300); fifty (33,250);
the county executive may increase the number of board members to
five (5), six (6), or seven (7), subject to the limitations of this section.
After the initial appointments, each board member shall be appointed
to serve for a term of four (4) years.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(b) The appointing authority shall appoint a member to fill a vacancy on the governing board within sixty (60) days after the vacancy occurs.
(1) in a city having a population of:
(A) more than one hundred
(B) more than one hundred
(2) in a city without a city hospital or other means for furnishing
the city's citizens hospital care; and
(3) that owns property in the city that:
(A) is used for hospital purposes; and
(B) has a value of at least four hundred thousand dollars
($400,000).
(1) in a city having a population of:
(A) more than
(B) more than
(2) in a county without a city or other public hospital;
(3) that admits persons for care and treatment without regard to race, color, or religious creed;
(4) the revenue of which derived from the care of persons able to pay and from all other sources is expended in the maintenance and operation of the hospital and for the care of persons who are unable to pay to the extent of the hospital's ability to do so;
(5) the revenue of which is insufficient to support and maintain the hospital and enable the hospital to supply the need and demand for hospital care and nursing in the city, either alone or in conjunction with other hospitals in the city; and
(6) in a city that has no city hospital under the city's control that is supported entirely by public money.
(1) is located in a township having a population of more than eight thousand (8,000) but less than ten thousand (10,000) located in a county having a population of more than
(2) has a majority of members who are residents of the township;
(3) is managed by directors, a majority of whom are residents of the township and who serve without compensation;
(4) is free from political or sectarian influence and is required by the hospital's articles of incorporation to be so managed and maintained perpetually; and
(5) is unable to be maintained and supported and to perform the hospital service reasonably needed and required for the people of the township without assistance, as determined by the township trustee and township board.
(b) The superintendent of hospitals located in a county described under subsection (a) must be a qualified hospital administrator or an experienced physician selected by the governing board. The board shall delegate to the superintendent and all other personnel the duties of the board's respective positions.
(1) more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(b) The board of managers of the hospital consists of seven (7) members chosen by the county executive. The members must:
(1) be chosen without regard for political affiliation;
(2) be citizens of the county; and
(3) include at least two (2) licensed physicians.
(c) The term of office of each member of the board is four (4) years. The terms of not more than two (2) of the managers expire annually. The terms of the members of the board may not be altered. The initial appointments are for the respective terms of three (3) years, two (2) years, and one (1) year. Appointments of successors are for terms of four (4) years. Appointments to fill vacancies are for the unexpired term.
applies to a county having a population of any of the following:
(1) More than one hundred seventy seventy-five thousand
(170,000) (175,000) but less than one hundred eighty eighty-five
thousand (180,000). (185,000).
(2) More than one hundred thirty twenty-five thousand (130,000)
(125,000) but less than one hundred forty-five thirty-five
thousand (145,000). (135,000).
(3) More than one hundred eighty-two eighty-five thousand seven
hundred ninety (182,790) (185,000) but less than two hundred
fifty thousand (200,000). (250,000).
(4) More than one hundred eighteen fifteen thousand (118,000)
(115,000) but less than one hundred twenty twenty-five thousand
(120,000). (125,000).
(b) The board of managers of a hospital for the treatment of patients
afflicted with tuberculosis or other diseases, including chronic diseases
and those requiring convalescent care, that contracts with other
counties for the treatment of the citizens of other counties, may provide
not more than one-half (1/2) of the cost of a program of group life
insurance and group health, accident, and hospitalization insurance for
the hospital's employees. The members of the families and dependents
of the employees may participate in a program of group health,
accident, and hospitalization insurance at no cost to the hospital.
(1) Having a consolidated city.
(2) Having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000).
(3) Having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(b) The business manager is directly responsible to and serves at the pleasure of the governing board. The governing board shall prescribe the duties of the business manager.
(1) A county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than two hundred
fifty thousand (250,000) but less than two hundred seventy
thousand (270,000).
(3) A county having a population of more than one hundred
seventy-five thousand (175,000) but less than one hundred
eighty-five thousand (185,000).
(4) A county having a population of more than one hundred
twenty-five thousand (125,000) but less than one hundred
thirty-five thousand (135,000).
(b) This chapter applies to a county, that if the county meets the
following conditions:
(1) Has a population of:
(A) more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than
four hundred thousand (400,000);
(B) more than two hundred thousand (200,000) but less than
three hundred thousand (300,000);
(C) more than one hundred seventy thousand (170,000) but
less than one hundred eighty thousand (180,000); or
(D) more than one hundred thirty thousand (130,000) but less
than one hundred forty-five thousand (145,000).
(2) (1) The county owns a hospital for the treatment of patients
with tuberculosis or other diseases, including chronic diseases
and diseases requiring convalescent care.
(3) (2) The county contracts with other counties for the treatment
of the citizens of those other counties.
(b) This subsection applies to a county with a population of more than
(1) before the effective date of the rule, the plat of the affected lot was recorded;
(2) there is not an available sewer line within seven hundred fifty (750) feet of the property line of the affected lot; and
(3) the local health department determines that the soil, although fill soil, is suitable for the installation of a residential septic system.
(b) This section applies if there is a:
(1) tie vote in an election for a member of the governing body of a school corporation; or
(2) vacancy on the governing body of a school corporation.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, if a tie vote occurs among any of the candidates for the governing body or a vacancy occurs on the governing body, the remaining members of the governing body, even if the remaining members do not constitute a majority of the governing body, shall by a majority vote of the remaining members:
(1) select one (1) of the candidates who shall be declared and certified elected; or
(2) fill the vacancy by appointing an individual to fill the vacancy.
(d) An individual appointed to fill a vacancy under subsection (c)(2):
(1) must satisfy all the qualifications required of a member of the governing body; and
(2) shall fill the remainder of the unexpired term of the vacating member.
(e) If a tie vote occurs among the remaining members of the governing body or the governing body fails to act within thirty (30) days after the election or the vacancy occurs, the fiscal body (as defined in IC 3-5-2-25) of the township in which the greatest percentage of population of the school district resides shall break the tie or make the appointment. A member of the fiscal body who was a candidate and is involved in a tie vote may not cast a vote under this subsection.
(f) If the fiscal body of a township is required to act under this section and a vote in the fiscal body results in a tie, the deciding vote to break the tie vote shall be cast by the executive.
(1) The number of members of the governing body, which shall be:
(A) three (3);
(B) five (5); or
(C) seven (7);
members.
(2) Whether the governing board shall be elected, appointed, or both.
(3) If appointed, when and by whom, and a general description of the manner of appointment that conforms with the requirements of IC 20-23-4-28.
(4) A provision that the members of an elected governing board shall be elected at the general election at which county officials are elected.
(5) If the governing board will have members who are elected and members who are appointed, the following information:
(A) The number of appointed members.
(B) When and by whom each of the appointed members are appointed.
(C) A general description of the manner of appointment that conforms with the requirements of IC 20-23-4-28.
(D) The number of elected members.
(E) A general description of the manner of election that conforms with the requirements of IC 20-23-4-27.
(6) The limitations on:
(A) residence;
(B) term of office; and
(C) other qualifications;
required by members of the governing body.
(7) The time the plan takes effect.
A plan or proposed plan may have additional details to make the provisions of the plan workable. The details may include provisions relating to the commencement or length of terms of office of the members of the governing body taking office under the plan.
(b) Except as provided in subsection (a)(1), in a city having a population of more than
corporation located in a city having a population of more than ninety
eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five
eighty thousand (105,000). four hundred (80,400).
(b) The city legislative body may adopt an ordinance to increase the
membership of the governing body of a school corporation to seven (7)
members.
(c) The ordinance must provide the following:
(1) The additional members of the governing body are to be
appointed by the city executive.
(2) If the plan is subsequently changed to provide for the election
of governing body members:
(A) the membership of the governing body may not be less
than seven (7); and
(B) the members of the governing body are to be elected.
(3) The initial terms of the members appointed under this section.
(4) The effective date of the ordinance.
(d) An ordinance adopted under this section:
(1) supersedes a part of the plan that conflicts with the ordinance;
(2) must be filed with the state superintendent under section 22 of
this chapter; and
(3) may only be amended or repealed by the city legislative body.
the governing body consists of a board of trustees of five (5) members elected in the manner provided in this chapter.
(b) The governing body members shall be elected at the times provided and shall succeed the retiring members in the order and manner as set forth in this chapter.
SECTION 7, IS AMENDED TO READ AS FOLLOWS [EFFECTIVE
APRIL 1, 2012]: Sec. 2. As used in this chapter, "school corporation"
means a school corporation that is located in a city having a population
of more than thirteen twelve thousand nine five hundred (13,900)
(12,500) but less than fourteen twelve thousand two seven hundred
(14,200). (12,700).
(1) is located in a county having a population of:
(A) more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000); or
(B) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(2) has at least twenty thousand (20,000) students.
(1) proceedings have been undertaken in good faith to form a community school corporation by the consolidation of two (2) or more prior established school corporations;
(2) the community school corporation is held, by a final order and decision of a court, to be invalidly formed and nonexistent; and
(3) the order and decision are not subject to further judicial review;
any bonds issued (before the final order and decision of the court) in the name of the community school corporation to provide funds to be applied on the cost of construction and equipment of a school building are not invalid by reason of the final order and decision of the court but constitute the valid and binding obligation of the prior established school corporation in the territory where the school building was or is being constructed, the same as if the bonds had been validly issued in the name of the prior established school corporation.
(b) This section applies only if the bonds at the time of their issuance would have been within the limitation of indebtedness imposed by the Constitution of the State of Indiana on the prior established school corporation.
(1) located in a city that has a population of more than
(2) for which a referendum has been held:
(A) as required by statute; and
(B) in which a majority of the votes cast approves choosing the members of the governing body as provided in this chapter.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
the township trustee, in administering the recreation program under this chapter, may supplement the funds by making a reasonable charge for admission to any outdoor swimming pool located on the school township property and owned by the school township.
(b) With the approval of the township board, the township trustee shall establish the admission fee or a schedule of admission fees to be collected for the use of the swimming pool. Fees collected shall be deposited in a recreation fund established under this chapter. Disbursements for personal services, operation, maintenance, and repairs of the swimming pool shall be paid from the recreation fund.
(1) more than
hundred (25,800) but less than twenty-seven twenty-six
thousand two hundred (27,200); (26,000); or
(2) more than one hundred forty-five fifty thousand (145,000)
(150,000) but less than one hundred forty-eight seventy thousand
(148,000). (170,000).
(b) Notwithstanding sections 32 and 33 of this chapter, in a county
that has not been completely reorganized under IC 20-23-4, the
governing body of each school corporation constituting a separate
attendance district under section 30 of this chapter shall appoint an
attendance officer. One (1) additional attendance officer may be
appointed for every seven thousand five hundred (7,500) students in
ADA in the school corporation. The governing body of each school
corporation that does not individually constitute a separate attendance
district may appoint an attendance officer.
(c) If the governing body of the school corporation makes an
appointment under this section, it shall appoint an individual who is
nominated by the superintendent of the school corporation. However,
the governing body may decline to appoint a nominee and may require
another nomination to be made by the superintendent. If the governing
body has discretion in whether to appoint an attendance officer under
subsection (b) and declines to make an appointment, the superintendent
of the school corporation involved shall serve as ex officio attendance
officer under section 35 of this chapter.
(d) The salary, including fringe benefits, of each attendance officer
appointed under this section shall be fixed by the governing body of the
school corporation and shall be paid by the treasurer of the school
corporation.
(e) Each attendance officer appointed under this section is entitled
to receive reimbursement from the school corporation for the actual
and necessary expenses incurred by the attendance officer in the proper
performance of the attendance officer's duties.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000), but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than one hundred
must obtain a unified license bond as provided in this chapter. This unified license bond is in lieu of any other bond for this type of work
required by the county or a city or town within that county, and the
bond must be in an amount equal to five thousand dollars ($5,000).
(b) The unified license bond shall be held for compliance with the
ordinances and regulations governing business in the county, or a city
or town within that county. The unified license bond required by this
chapter shall be filed with the county recorder.
(1) A city having a population of more than eighty thousand (80,000) but less than eighty thousand four hundred (80,400).
(2) A city having a population of more than eighty thousand five hundred (80,500) but less than one hundred thousand (100,000).
(b) An insurer that issued an insurance policy covering a building or other structure that is:
(1) located in a city; and
(2) damaged by a fire or explosion;
shall notify the enforcement authority of the city about the existence of the policy. However, an insurer is not required to notify the enforcement authority under this section if the policy issued by the insurer is not in effect at the time of the fire or explosion that damages the building or structure.
(c) The insurer shall provide the notice required under this section if the enforcement authority makes a request for the notice within twenty (20) days after the damage occurs.
(d) The notice required by this section must:
(1) be in writing;
(2) identify the insurer and state the insurer's address;
(3) identify the building or structure and state the location of the building or structure; and
(4) disclose the nature and extent of the coverage of the building
or structure provided by the policy.
(e) An insurer shall provide notice to the enforcement authority
under this section within ten (10) days after the insurer is notified
under subsection (c) of the damaging of the building or structure by fire
or explosion.
(f) The commissioner may take action under IC 27-1-3-10 and
IC 27-1-3-19 against an insurer that violates this section.
(b) Notwithstanding section 3 of this chapter, the juvenile court shall operate a juvenile detention facility or juvenile shelter care facility established in the county. However, the county legislative body shall determine the budget for the juvenile detention facility or juvenile shelter care facility. The expenses for the juvenile detention facility shall be paid from the county general fund.
(b) Except as otherwise provided in a statement described in:
(1) IC 32-25-7-1(a)(10) and included in:
(A) the declaration; or
(B) an amendment to the declaration, if the amendment is approved by at least ninety-five percent (95%) of co-owners; or
(2) IC 32-25-8-2(12) and included in:
(A) the bylaws; or
(B) an amendment to the bylaws, if the amendment is approved by the percentage of votes set forth in the bylaws under IC 32-25-8-2(11);
part or all of the common areas and facilities of a condominium may be conveyed or subjected to a security interest by the association of co-owners if at least ninety-five percent (95%) of the co-owners,
including at least ninety-five percent (95%) of the co-owners of
condominium units not owned by the declarant, agree to the action.
However, if the common areas and facilities proposed to be conveyed
or encumbered under this section include any limited common areas
and facilities, all the owners of the limited common areas and facilities
to be conveyed or encumbered must agree to the conveyance or
encumbrance.
(c) An agreement to convey or encumber common areas and
facilities under this section must be evidenced by an agreement:
(1) executed in the same manner as a deed or any other instrument
recognized by the state for the conveyance or transfer of interests
in title; and
(2) signed by:
(A) at least ninety-five percent (95%) of the co-owners, as
required by this section; or
(B) another percentage of the co-owners specified in a
statement described in subsection (b)(1) or (b)(2).
An agreement under this subsection is effective upon being recorded.
(d) Proceeds from the conveyance or encumbrance of common areas
and facilities under this section shall be distributed to co-owners as
common profits under IC 32-25-8-6. However, if the common areas
and facilities conveyed or encumbered under this section include
limited common areas and facilities, proceeds from the conveyance or
encumbrance of the limited common areas and facilities shall be
distributed to the owners of the limited common areas and facilities
according to the percentage of the owners' undivided interest in the
limited common areas and facilities.
(e) A conveyance or encumbrance of common areas and facilities
not made in accordance with:
(1) this section; or
(2) a statement described in subsection (b)(1) or (b)(2);
is void.
(1) A description of the land on which the building and improvements are or are to be located.
(2) A description of the building, stating:
(A) the number of stories and basements; and
(B) the number of condominium units.
(3) A description of the common areas and facilities.
(4) A description of the limited common areas and facilities, if any, stating to which condominium units their use is reserved.
(5) The percentage of undivided interest in the common areas and facilities appertaining to each condominium unit and its owner for all purposes, including voting.
(6) A statement of the percentage of votes by the condominium unit owners required to determine whether to:
(A) rebuild;
(B) repair;
(C) restore; or
(D) sell;
the property if all or part of the property is damaged or destroyed.
(7) Any covenants and restrictions in regard to the use of:
(A) the condominium units; and
(B) common areas and facilities.
(8) Any further details in connection with the property that:
(A) the person executing the declaration considers desirable; and
(B) are consistent with this article.
(9) The method by which the declaration may be amended in a manner consistent with this chapter.
(10) This subdivision applies only to a condominium located on the shore of a lake located in a township with a population of more than three thousand
(b) A true copy of the bylaws shall be annexed to and made a part of the declaration.
(c) The record of the declaration shall contain a reference to the:
(1) book;
(2) page; and
(3) date of record;
of the floor plans of the building affected by the declaration.
(1) With respect to the board of directors:
(A) the election of the board from among the co-owners;
(B) the number of persons constituting the board;
(C) the expiration of the terms of at least one-third (1/3) of the directors annually;
(D) the powers and duties of the board, including whether the board may engage the services of a manager or managing agent;
(E) the compensation, if any, of the directors; and
(F) the method of removal from office of directors.
(2) The method of calling meetings of the co-owners and the percentage, if other than a majority of co-owners, that constitutes a quorum.
(3) The election from among the board of directors of a president, who shall preside over the meetings of:
(A) the board of directors; and
(B) the association of co-owners.
(4) The election of a secretary, who shall keep the minute book in which resolutions shall be recorded.
(5) The election of a treasurer, who shall keep the financial records and books of account.
(6) The maintenance, repair, and replacement of the common areas and facilities and payments for that maintenance, repair, and replacement, including the method of approving payment vouchers.
(7) The manner of collecting from each condominium owner the owner's share of the common expenses.
(8) The designation and removal of personnel necessary for the maintenance, repair, and replacement of the common areas and facilities.
(9) The method of adopting and of amending administrative rules governing the details of the operation and use of the common areas and facilities.
(10) The restrictions on and requirements respecting the use and
maintenance of the condominium units and the use of the
common areas and facilities that are:
(A) not set forth in the declaration; and
(B) designed to prevent unreasonable interference with the use
of their respective units and of the common areas and facilities
by the several co-owners.
(11) The percentage of votes required to amend the bylaws.
(12) This subdivision applies only to a condominium located on
the shore of a lake located in a township with a population of
more than three thousand one hundred (3,100) (3,000) but less
than three thousand eight one hundred (3,800) (3,100) located in
a county having a population of more than forty-five forty-seven
thousand (45,000) (47,000) but less than forty-five forty-seven
thousand nine five hundred (45,900). (47,500). A statement of the
percentage of votes by the condominium unit owners required to
convey or encumber part or all of the common areas and facilities.
A statement under this subdivision may not allow less than
ninety-five percent (95%) of the condominium unit owners, or
less than ninety-five percent (95%) of the owners of condominium
units not owned by the declarant, to convey or encumber part or
all of the common areas and facilities. If the bylaws do not
include a statement under this subdivision, IC 32-25-4-3.5
applies.
(13) Other provisions consistent with this article considered
necessary for the administration of the property.
(b) The official reporter shall, when required by the recorder's
appointing judge, do the following:
(1) Be promptly present in the appointing judge's court.
(2) Record the oral evidence given in all causes by any approved
method, including both questions and answers.
(3) Note all rulings of the judge concerning the admission and
rejection of evidence and the objections and exceptions to the
admission and rejection of evidence.
(4) Write out the instructions of the court in jury trials.
(c) In counties in which the circuit or probate court sits as a juvenile
court, the official reporter of the circuit court or probate court, as the
case may be:
(1) shall report the proceedings of the juvenile court as part of the
reporter's duties as reporter of the circuit or probate court; and
(2) except as provided in subsection (d), may not receive
additional compensation for the reporter's services for reporting
the proceedings of the juvenile court.
(d) In counties in which a circuit court has juvenile jurisdiction and
where there is a juvenile referee and the circuit judge is the judge of the
juvenile court, the salary of the juvenile court reporter is one hundred
twenty-five dollars ($125) per month in addition to any compensation
the reporter receives as reporter of the circuit court.
(e) The official reporters of juvenile courts shall:
(1) be paid the same amount for their services and in the same
manner;
(2) have the same duties; and
(3) be subject to the same restrictions;
as is provided for by law for the official reporters of the other courts.
However, in a county having a population of more than two six
hundred fifty thousand (250,000), (600,000), the judge of the juvenile
court may appoint court reporters as necessary for compliance with the
law in regard to the reporting of cases and facilitating and expediting
the trial of causes, each of whom is entitled to receive a salary of at
least three hundred dollars ($300) per month.
(1) specify in the record the conditions of the probation; and
(2) advise the person that if the person violates a condition of probation during the probationary period, a petition to revoke probation may be filed before the earlier of the following:
(A) One (1) year after the termination of probation.
(B) Forty-five (45) days after the state receives notice of the violation.
(b) In addition, if the person was convicted of a felony and is placed on probation, the court shall order the person to pay to the probation department the user's fee prescribed under subsection (d). If the person was convicted of a misdemeanor, the court may order the person to pay the user's fee prescribed under subsection (e). The court may:
(1) modify the conditions (except a fee payment may only be modified as provided in section 1.7(b) of this chapter); or
(2) terminate the probation;
at any time. If the person commits an additional crime, the court may revoke the probation.
(c) If a clerk of a court collects a probation user's fee, the clerk:
(1) may keep not more than three percent (3%) of the fee to defray the administrative costs of collecting the fee and shall deposit any fee kept under this subsection in the clerk's record perpetuation fund established under IC 33-37-5-2; and
(2) if requested to do so by the county auditor, city fiscal officer, or town fiscal officer under clause (A), (B), or (C), may transfer not more than three percent (3%) of the fee to the:
(A) county auditor, who shall deposit the money transferred under this subdivision into the county general fund;
(B) city general fund when requested by the city fiscal officer; or
(C) town general fund when requested by the town fiscal officer.
(d) In addition to any other conditions of probation, the court shall order each person convicted of a felony to pay:
(1) not less than twenty-five dollars ($25) nor more than one hundred dollars ($100) as an initial probation user's fee;
(2) a monthly probation user's fee of not less than fifteen dollars ($15) nor more than thirty dollars ($30) for each month that the person remains on probation;
(3) the costs of the laboratory test or series of tests to detect and confirm the presence of the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) antigen or antibodies to the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) if such tests are required by the court under section 2.3 of this chapter;
(4) an alcohol abuse deterrent fee and a medical fee set by the court under IC 9-30-9-8, if the court has referred the defendant to an alcohol abuse deterrent program; and
(5) an administrative fee of one hundred dollars ($100);
to either the probation department or the clerk.
(e) In addition to any other conditions of probation, the court may order each person convicted of a misdemeanor to pay:
(1) not more than a fifty dollar ($50) initial probation user's fee;
(2) a monthly probation user's fee of not less than ten dollars ($10) nor more than twenty dollars ($20) for each month that the person remains on probation;
(3) the costs of the laboratory test or series of tests to detect and confirm the presence of the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) antigen or antibodies to the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV) if such tests are required by the court under section 2.3 of this chapter; and
(4) an administrative fee of fifty dollars ($50);
to either the probation department or the clerk.
(f) The probation department or clerk shall collect the administrative fees under subsections (d)(5) and (e)(4) before collecting any other fee under subsection (d) or (e). All money collected by the probation department or the clerk under this section shall be transferred to the county treasurer, who shall deposit the money into the county supplemental adult probation services fund. The fiscal body of the county shall appropriate money from the county supplemental adult probation services fund:
(1) to the county, superior, circuit, or municipal court of the county that provides probation services to adults to supplement adult probation services; and
(2) to supplement the salaries of probation officers in accordance with the schedule adopted by the county fiscal body under IC 36-2-16.5.
(g) The probation department or clerk shall collect the administrative fee under subsection (e)(4) before collecting any other fee under subsection (e). All money collected by the probation department or the clerk of a city or town court under this section shall be transferred to the fiscal officer of the city or town for deposit into the local supplemental adult probation services fund. The fiscal body of the city or town shall appropriate money from the local supplemental adult probation services fund to the city or town court of the city or town for the court's use in providing probation services to adults or for the court's use for other purposes as may be appropriated by the fiscal body. Money may be appropriated under this subsection only to those city or town courts that have an adult probation services program. If a city or town court does not have such a program, the money collected by the probation department must be transferred and appropriated as
provided under subsection (f).
(h) Except as provided in subsection (j), the county or local
supplemental adult probation services fund may be used only to
supplement probation services and to supplement salaries for probation
officers. A supplemental probation services fund may not be used to
replace other funding of probation services. Any money remaining in
the fund at the end of the year does not revert to any other fund but
continues in the county or local supplemental adult probation services
fund.
(i) A person placed on probation for more than one (1) crime:
(1) may be required to pay more than one (1) initial probation
user's fee; and
(2) may not be required to pay more than one (1) monthly
probation user's fee per month;
to the probation department or the clerk.
(j) This subsection applies to a city or town located in a county
having a population of more than one hundred eighty-two eighty-five
thousand seven hundred ninety (182,790) (185,000) but less than two
hundred fifty thousand (200,000). (250,000). Any money remaining in
the local supplemental adult probation services fund at the end of the
local fiscal year may be appropriated by the city or town fiscal body to
the city or town court for use by the court for purposes determined by
the fiscal body.
(k) In addition to other methods of payment allowed by law, a
probation department may accept payment of fees required under this
section and section 1.5 of this chapter by credit card (as defined in
IC 14-11-1-7). The liability for payment is not discharged until the
probation department receives payment or credit from the institution
responsible for making the payment or credit.
(l) The probation department may contract with a bank or credit
card vendor for acceptance of bank or credit cards. However, if there
is a vendor transaction charge or discount fee, whether billed to the
probation department or charged directly to the probation department's
account, the probation department may collect a credit card service fee
from the person using the bank or credit card. The fee collected under
this subsection is a permitted additional charge to the money the
probation department is required to collect under subsection (d) or (e).
(m) The probation department shall forward the credit card service
fees collected under subsection (l) to the county treasurer or city or
town fiscal officer in accordance with subsection (f) or (g). These funds
may be used without appropriation to pay the transaction charge or
discount fee charged by the bank or credit card vendor.
(b) Firearms shall be returned to the rightful owner at once following final disposition of the cause if a return has not already occurred under the terms of IC 35-33-5. If the rightful ownership is not known the law enforcement agency holding the firearm shall make a reasonable attempt to ascertain the rightful ownership and cause the return of the firearm. However, nothing in this chapter shall be construed as requiring the return of firearms to rightful owners who have been convicted for the misuse of firearms. In such cases, the court may provide for the return of the firearm in question or order that the firearm be at once delivered:
(1) except as provided in subdivision (2), to the sheriff's department of the county in which the offense occurred; or
(2) to the city or town police force that confiscated the firearm, if:
(A) a member of the city or town police force confiscated the firearm; and
(B) the city or town has a population of more than two thousand five hundred (2,500) and less than
(c) The receiving law enforcement agency shall dispose of firearms under subsection (b), at the discretion of the law enforcement agency, not more than one hundred twenty (120) days following receipt by use of any of the following procedures:
(1) Public sale of the firearms to the general public as follows:
(A) Notice of the sale shall be:
(i) posted for ten (10) days in the county courthouse in a place readily accessible to the general public; and
(ii) advertised in the principal newspaper of the county for two (2) days in an advertisement that appears in the newspaper at least five (5) days prior to the sale.
(B) Disposition of the firearm shall be by public auction in a place convenient to the general public, with disposition going to the highest bidder. However, no firearm shall be transferred to any bidder if that bidder is not lawfully eligible to receive and possess firearms according to the laws of the United States and Indiana.
(C) All handguns transferred under this subdivision shall also be transferred according to the transfer procedures set forth in this article.
(D) Money collected pursuant to the sales shall first be used to defray the necessary costs of administering this subdivision with any surplus to be:
(i) deposited into the receiving law enforcement agency's firearms training fund, if the law enforcement agency is a county law enforcement agency, or into a continuing education fund established under IC 5-2-8-2, if the law enforcement agency is a city or town law enforcement agency; and
(ii) used by the agency exclusively for the purpose of training law enforcement officers in the proper use of firearms or other law enforcement duties, if the law enforcement agency is a county law enforcement agency, or for law enforcement purposes, if the law enforcement agency is a city or town law enforcement agency.
(2) Sale of the firearms to a licensed firearms dealer as follows:
(A) Notice of the sale must be:
(i) posted for ten (10) days in the county courthouse in a place readily accessible to the general public; and
(ii) advertised in the principal newspaper of the county for two (2) days in an advertisement that appears in the newspaper at least five (5) days before the sale.
(B) Disposition of the firearm shall be by auction with disposition going to the highest bidder who is a licensed firearms dealer.
(C) Money collected from the sales shall first be used to defray the necessary costs of administering this subdivision and any surplus shall be:
(i) deposited into the receiving law enforcement agency's firearms training fund or other appropriate training activities fund; and
(ii) used by the agency exclusively for the purpose of training law enforcement officers in the proper use of firearms or other law enforcement duties.
(3) Sale or transfer of the firearms to another law enforcement agency.
(4) Release to the state police department laboratory or other forensic laboratory administered by the state or a political subdivision (as defined in IC 36-1-2-13) for the purposes of research, training, and comparison in conjunction with the forensic examination of firearms evidence.
(5) Destruction of the firearms.
(d) Notwithstanding the requirement of this section mandating disposal of firearms not more than one hundred twenty (120) days following receipt, the receiving law enforcement agency may at its discretion hold firearms it may receive until a sufficient number has accumulated to defray the costs of administering this section if a delay does not exceed one hundred eighty (180) days from the date of receipt of the first firearm in the sale lot. In any event, all confiscated firearms shall be disposed of as promptly as possible.
(e) When a firearm is delivered to the state police department laboratory or other forensic laboratory under subsection (c)(4) and the state police department laboratory or other forensic laboratory determines the laboratory has no further need for the firearm in question, the laboratory shall return the firearm to the law enforcement agency for disposal under subsection (c).
(b) Firearms shall be returned to the rightful owner at once following final disposition of the cause, if such return has not already occurred under the terms of IC 35-33-5, and if such owner remains lawfully entitled to possess such firearms according to applicable United States and Indiana statutes. If rightful ownership is not known, the law enforcement agency holding the firearm shall make a reasonable and diligent effort to ascertain the rightful ownership and cause the return of the firearm being held, providing the owner remains lawfully entitled to possess such firearms.
(c) Firearms that are not returnable under this section shall be at once delivered to:
(1) the sheriff's department of the county in which the offense occurred, unless subdivision (2) applies; or
(2) the city or town police force that confiscated the firearm if:
(A) a member of the city or town police force confiscated the firearm; and
(B) the city or town has a population of more than two thousand five hundred (2,500) and less than
following final disposition of the cause.
(d) When firearms are sent to a law enforcement agency under subsection (c), the law enforcement agency may upon request release the firearms to the state police department laboratory or other forensic laboratory administered by the state or a political subdivision (as
defined in IC 36-1-2-13) for the purposes of research, training, and
comparison in conjunction with the forensic examination of firearms
evidence.
(e) The receiving law enforcement agency or laboratory shall cause
the registry of such firearms in the United States National Firearms
Registration and Transfer Record within thirty (30) days following
receipt from the court.
(f) The court may order such firearms as are not returnable
destroyed, specifying the exact manner of destruction and requiring the
receiving law enforcement agency or laboratory to make due return to
the ordering court the time, date, method of destruction, and disposition
of the remains of the destroyed firearm.
(g) No portion of this section shall be construed as requiring the
receiving law enforcement agency or laboratory to retain firearms
which are inoperable or unserviceable, or which the receiving law
enforcement agency or laboratory may choose to transfer as public
property in the ordinary course of lawful commerce and exchange.
(1)
(2)
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the legislative body of
(1) Board of tenant concerns (formerly governed by IC 18-7-11.5).
(2) Regulation of sewers and drains (formerly governed by IC 19-2-11).
(3) Department of waterworks (formerly governed by IC 19-3-27).
(4) Benefits for certain municipal utility employees (formerly governed by IC 19-3-29).
(c) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the legislative body of
having a population of more than thirty-five thousand (35,000) but less
than one hundred fifteen thousand (115,000): of Gary, the city of
Hammond, the city of South Bend, and the city of Mishawaka:
(1) Regulation of sewers and drains (formerly governed by
IC 19-2-11).
(2) Department of waterworks (formerly governed by IC 19-3-27).
(3) Benefits for certain municipal utility employees (formerly
governed by IC 19-3-29).
(1) A county having a consolidated city.
(2)
(3) St. Joseph County.
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the legislative body of each city having a population of more than fifty thousand (50,000):
(1) Regulation of sewers and drains (formerly governed by IC 19-2-11).
(2) Benefits for certain municipal utility employees (formerly governed by IC 19-3-29).
(c) Jurisdiction over the following local matter, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly has been the subject of statutory concern, is transferred to the legislative body of each city having a population of more than thirty-five thousand (35,000), but less than fifty thousand (50,000):
Regulation of sewers and drains (formerly governed by IC 19-2-11).
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the legislative body of the county:
(1) Frequency of salary payments (formerly governed by IC 17-3-73-2).
(2) Mileage allowances for deputy county auditors (formerly governed by IC 17-3-29-1).
(3) County purchasing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-77).
(4) County data processing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-74).
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1982 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the executive of the county:
(1) Motor vehicles for the county surveyor (formerly governed by IC 17-3-69-1).
(2) County purchasing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-77).
(3) County data processing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-73 or IC 17-2-74).
(4) Natural beauty roads (formerly governed by IC 19-7-17.5).
(5) Building and minimum housing department of the county (formerly governed by IC 17-2-72.3).
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the legislative body of the county:
(1) County purchasing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-77).
(2) County data processing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-74).
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the executive of the county:
(1) County purchasing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-77).
(2) County data processing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-74).
(3) Control of county parks (formerly governed by IC 17-2-76).
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matters, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly have been subjects of statutory concern, is transferred to the executive of the county:
(1) County purchasing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-77).
(2) County data processing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-74).
(b) Jurisdiction over the following local matter, which before the 1981 regular session of the general assembly has been the subject of statutory concern, is transferred to the executive of the county:
County purchasing agency (formerly governed by IC 17-2-77).
(1) more than
(2) more than
(3) more than
(b) Notwithstanding section 3(c) of this chapter, the fiscal body of a city must approve:
(1) every sale of real property having an appraised value of ten thousand dollars ($10,000) or more;
(2) every lease of real property for which the total annual rental payments will be five thousand dollars ($5,000) or more; and
(3) every transfer of real property under section 14 or 15 of this chapter.
(1) real property; or
(2) tangible or intangible personal property, licenses, or any interest in the tangible or intangible personal property;
for no compensation or a nominal fee to a nonprofit corporation created for agricultural, educational, or recreational purposes.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
The executive shall divide the county into three (3) districts that are composed of contiguous territory and are reasonably compact. The district boundaries drawn by the executive must not cross precinct boundary lines and must divide townships only when a division is clearly necessary to accomplish redistricting under this section. If necessary, the county auditor shall call a special meeting of the executive to establish or revise districts.
(b) This subsection applies to a county having a population of more
than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred
thousand (700,000). A county redistricting commission shall divide the
county into three (3) single-member districts that comply with
subsection (d). The commission is composed of:
(1) the members of the Indiana election commission;
(2) two (2) members of the senate selected by the president pro
tempore, one (1) from each political party; and
(3) two (2) members of the house of representatives selected by
the speaker, one (1) from each political party.
The legislative members of the commission have no vote and may act
only in an advisory capacity. A majority vote of the voting members is
required for the commission to take action. The commission may meet
as frequently as necessary to perform its duty under this subsection.
The commission's members serve without additional compensation
above that provided for them as members of the Indiana election
commission, the senate, or the house of representatives.
(c) This subsection applies to a county having a population of more
than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than
three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000). (270,000). The
executive shall divide the county into three (3) single-member districts
that comply with subsection (d).
(d) Single-member districts established under subsection (b) or (c)
must:
(1) be compact, subject only to natural boundary lines (such as
railroads, major highways, rivers, creeks, parks, and major
industrial complexes);
(2) contain, as nearly as is possible, equal population; and
(3) not cross precinct lines.
(e) A division under subsection (a), (b), or (c) shall be made:
(1) during the first year after a year in which a federal decennial
census is conducted; and
(2) when the county adopts an order declaring a county boundary
to be changed under IC 36-2-1-2.
(f) A division under subsection (a), (b), or (c) may be made in any
odd-numbered year not described in subsection (e).
(b) A member of the executive must reside within:
(1) the county as provided in Article 6, Section 6 of the Constitution of the State of Indiana; and
(2) the district from which the member was elected.
(c) Except as provided in subsection (e), if the person does not remain a resident of the county and district after taking office, the person forfeits the office. The county fiscal body shall declare the office vacant whenever a member of the executive forfeits office under this subsection.
(d) In a county having a population of:
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
one (1) member of the executive shall be elected by the voters of each of the three (3) single-member districts established under section 4(b) or 4(c) of this chapter. In other counties, all three (3) members of the executive shall be elected by the voters of the whole county.
(e) This subsection applies to a member of the executive who must reside within the district from which the member was elected. A person who:
(1) has begun a term of office as a member of the executive; and
(2) is relocated outside the member's district as the result of the state's acquisition of the member's residence for a public use;
may complete the member's term of office as long as the member remains a resident of the county that contains the member's district.
(b) Notwithstanding subsection (a), in a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
The county executive shall, by ordinance, divide the county into four (4) contiguous, single-member districts that comply with subsection (d). If necessary, the county auditor shall call a special meeting of the executive to establish or revise districts. One (1) member of the fiscal body shall be elected by the voters of each of the four (4) districts. Three (3) at-large members of the fiscal body shall be elected by the voters of the whole county.
(b) This subsection applies to a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000). The county redistricting commission established under IC 36-2-2-4 shall divide the county into seven (7) single-member districts that comply with subsection (d). One (1) member of the fiscal body shall be elected by the voters of each of these seven (7) single-member districts.
(c) This subsection applies to a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(d) Single-member districts established under subsection (a), (b), or (c) must:
(1) be compact, subject only to natural boundary lines (such as railroads, major highways, rivers, creeks, parks, and major industrial complexes);
(2) not cross precinct boundary lines;
(3) contain, as nearly as possible, equal population; and
(4) include whole townships, except when a division is clearly necessary to accomplish redistricting under this section.
(e) A division under subsection (a), (b), or (c) shall be made:
(1) during the first year after a year in which a federal decennial census is conducted; and
(2) when the county executive adopts an order declaring a county boundary to be changed under IC 36-2-1-2.
(f) A division under subsection (a), (b), or (c) may be made in any odd-numbered year not described in subsection (e).
(1) a county having a population of:
(A) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(B) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(2) any other county not having a consolidated city, if both the county executive and the county fiscal body adopt identical ordinances providing for the county to be governed by this chapter beginning on a specified effective date.
(b) This section applies only:
(1) to a county having a population of less than
(2) if the legislative body for the county elects by ordinance to implement this section.
(c) A person who is:
(1) sentenced under this article for a felony or a misdemeanor;
(2) subject to lawful detention in a county jail for a period of more than six (6) hours;
(3) not a member of a family that makes less than one hundred fifty percent (150%) of the federal income poverty level; and
(4) not detained as a child subject to the jurisdiction of a juvenile court;
shall reimburse the county for the costs described in subsection (d).
(d) A person described in subsection (c) shall reimburse the county for the sum of the following amounts:
(1) The lesser of:
(A) the per diem amount specified under subsection (e); or
(B) fifty dollars ($50);
multiplied by each day or part of a day that the person is lawfully detained in a county jail or lawfully detained under IC 35-33-11-3 for more than six (6) hours.
(2) The direct cost of investigating whether the person is indigent.
(3) The cost of collecting the amount for which the person is liable under this section.
(e) The county fiscal body shall fix the per diem described in subsection (d)(1)(A) in an amount that is reasonably related to the average daily cost of housing a person in the county jail. If the county transfers the person to another county or the department of correction
under IC 35-33-11-3, the per diem is equal to the per diem charged to
the county under IC 35-33-11-5.
(f) The county sheriff shall collect the amounts due from a person
under this section in conformity with the procedures specified in the
ordinance adopted under subsection (b). If the county sheriff does not
collect the amount due to the county, the county attorney may collect
the amount due.
STATUS AND POPULATION CLASS
Cities of 600,000
Cities of 35,000 to 599,999
Cities of less than 35,000 Third class cities
Other municipalities of any
population Towns
(b) Except as provided in subsection (c), a city that attains a population of thirty-five thousand (35,000) remains a second class city even though its population decreases to less than thirty-five thousand (35,000) at the next federal decennial census.
(c) The legislative body of a city to which subsection (b) applies may, by ordinance, adopt third class city status.
(1) Territory that is contiguous to the municipality.
(2) Territory that is not contiguous to the municipality and is occupied by a municipally owned or operated airport or landing field.
(3) Territory that is not contiguous to the municipality but is found by the legislative body to be occupied by a municipally owned or regulated sanitary landfill, golf course, or hospital. However, if territory annexed under this subsection ceases to be used as a municipally owned or regulated sanitary landfill, golf course, or hospital for at least one (1) year, the territory reverts to the jurisdiction of the unit having jurisdiction before the annexation if the unit that had jurisdiction over the territory still exists. If the unit no longer exists, the territory reverts to the jurisdiction of the unit that would currently have jurisdiction over the territory if the
annexation had not occurred. The clerk of the municipality shall
notify the offices required to receive notice of a disannexation
under section 19 of this chapter when the territory reverts to the
jurisdiction of the unit having jurisdiction before the annexation.
(b) This subsection applies to municipalities in a county having a
population of:
(1) more than seventy-three seventy thousand (73,000) fifty
(70,050) but less than seventy-four seventy-one thousand
(74,000); (71,000);
(2) more than seventy-one seventy-five thousand four hundred
(71,400) (75,000) but less than seventy-three seventy-seven
thousand (73,000); (77,000);
(3) more than seventy seventy-one thousand (70,000) (71,000) but
less than seventy-one seventy-five thousand (71,000); (75,000);
(4) more than forty-five forty-seven thousand (45,000) (47,000)
but less than forty-five forty-seven thousand nine five hundred
(45,900); (47,500);
(5) more than forty thirty-eight thousand nine five hundred
(40,900) (38,500) but less than forty-one thirty-nine thousand
(41,000); (39,000);
(6) more than thirty-eight thirty-seven thousand (38,000) (37,000)
but less than thirty-nine thirty-seven thousand (39,000); one
hundred twenty-five (37,125);
(7) more than thirty thirty-three thousand (30,000) three hundred
(33,300) but less than thirty thirty-three thousand seven five
hundred (30,700); (33,500);
(8) more than twenty-three thousand five three hundred (23,500)
(23,300) but less than twenty-four thousand (24,000);
(9) more than one hundred eighty-two eighty-five thousand seven
hundred ninety (182,790) (185,000) but less than three two
hundred fifty thousand (300,000); or (250,000);
(10) more than two hundred fifty thousand (250,000) but less
than two hundred seventy thousand (270,000); or
(10) (11) more than thirty-four thirty-two thousand nine five
hundred fifty (34,950) (32,500) but less than thirty-six thirty-three
thousand (36,000). (33,000).
Except as provided in subsection (c), the legislative body of a
municipality to which this subsection applies may, by ordinance, annex
territory that is not contiguous to the municipality, has its entire area
not more than two (2) miles from the municipality's boundary, is to be
used for an industrial park containing one (1) or more businesses, and
is either owned by the municipality or by a property owner who
consents to the annexation. However, if territory annexed under this
subsection is not used as an industrial park within five (5) years after
the date of passage of the annexation ordinance, or if the territory
ceases to be used as an industrial park for at least one (1) year, the
territory reverts to the jurisdiction of the unit having jurisdiction before
the annexation if the unit that had jurisdiction over the territory still
exists. If the unit no longer exists, the territory reverts to the
jurisdiction of the unit that would currently have jurisdiction over the
territory if the annexation had not occurred. The clerk of the
municipality shall notify the offices entitled to receive notice of a
disannexation under section 19 of this chapter when the territory
reverts to the jurisdiction of the unit having jurisdiction before the
annexation.
(c) A city in a county with a population of more than two hundred
fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two hundred
seventy thousand (300,000) (270,000) may not annex territory as
prescribed in subsection (b) until the territory is zoned by the county
for industrial purposes.
(d) Notwithstanding any other law, territory that is annexed under
subsection (b) or (h) is not considered a part of the municipality for the
purposes of:
(1) annexing additional territory:
(A) in a county that is not described by clause (B); or
(B) in a county having a population of more than two hundred
fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two
hundred seventy thousand (300,000), (270,000), unless the
boundaries of the noncontiguous territory become contiguous to
the city, as allowed by Indiana law;
(2) expanding the municipality's extraterritorial jurisdictional area;
or
(3) changing an assigned service area under IC 8-1-2.3-6(1).
(e) As used in this section, "airport" and "landing field" have the
meanings prescribed by IC 8-22-1.
(f) As used in this section, "hospital" has the meaning prescribed by
IC 16-18-2-179(b).
(g) An ordinance adopted under this section must assign the territory
annexed by the ordinance to at least one (1) municipal legislative body
district.
(h) This subsection applies to a city having a population of more than
thirty-one twenty-nine thousand (31,000) nine hundred (29,900) but
less than thirty-two thirty-one thousand (32,000). (31,000). The city
legislative body of a city may, by ordinance, annex territory that:
(1) is not contiguous to the city;
(2) has its entire area not more than eight (8) miles from the city's boundary;
(3) does not extend more than:
(A) one and one-half (1 1/2) miles to the west;
(B) three-fourths (3/4) mile to the east;
(C) one-half (1/2) mile to the north; or
(D) one-half (1/2) mile to the south;
of an interchange of an interstate highway (as designated by the federal highway authorities) and a state highway (as designated by the state highway authorities); and
(4) is owned by the city or by a property owner that consents to the annexation.
(1) is contiguous to the municipality;
(2)
(A)
(B)
located in a county having a population of more than one hundred forty thousand
(3) is owned by a property owner who consents to the annexation.
(b) Territory annexed under this section is exempt from all property tax liability under IC 6-1.1 for municipal purposes for all portions of the annexed territory that are classified for zoning purposes as agricultural and remain exempt from the property tax liability while the property's zoning classification remains agricultural. However, if the annexation ordinance annexing the territory is adopted after June 30, 2006, the property tax liability under IC 6-1.1 for municipal purposes may be exempted for a period of not more than ten (10) years.
(c) There may not be a change in the zoning classification of territory annexed under this section without the consent of the owner of the annexed territory.
(d) Territory annexed under this section may not be considered a part of the municipality for purposes of annexing additional territory under section 3 or 4 of this chapter. However, territory annexed under this
section shall be considered a part of the municipality for purposes of
annexing additional territory under section 5 or 5.1 of this chapter.
(b) An ordinance adopted under subsection (a) must provide the following:
(1) A tax abatement program that is in effect for not more than three (3) taxable years after an annexation occurs.
(2) Except single family residential property described by subdivision (3), a tax abatement for all classes of property that does not exceed:
(A) seventy-five percent (75%) of a taxpayer's liability in the first year of the abatement program;
(B) fifty percent (50%) of a taxpayer's liability in the second year of the abatement program; and
(C) twenty-five percent (25%) of a taxpayer's liability in the third year of the abatement program.
(3) For a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(A) ninety percent (90%) of a taxpayer's liability in the first year of the abatement program;
(B) eighty percent (80%) of a taxpayer's liability in the second year of the abatement program;
(C) sixty percent (60%) of a taxpayer's liability in the third year of the abatement program;
(D) forty percent (40%) of a taxpayer's liability in the fourth year of the abatement program; and
(E) twenty percent (20%) of a taxpayer's liability in the fifth year of the abatement program.
(4) The procedure by which an eligible property owner receives a tax abatement under this section.
(1) The requirements of either subsection (b) or (c).
(2) The requirements of subsection (d).
(b) The requirements of this subsection are met if the evidence establishes the following:
(1) That the territory sought to be annexed is contiguous to the municipality.
(2) One (1) of the following:
(A) The resident population density of the territory sought to be annexed is at least three (3) persons per acre.
(B) Sixty percent (60%) of the territory is subdivided.
(C) The territory is zoned for commercial, business, or industrial uses.
(c) The requirements of this subsection are met if the evidence establishes the following:
(1) That the territory sought to be annexed is contiguous to the municipality as required by section 1.5 of this chapter, except that at least one-fourth (1/4), instead of one-eighth (1/8), of the aggregate external boundaries of the territory sought to be annexed must coincide with the boundaries of the municipality.
(2) That the territory sought to be annexed is needed and can be used by the municipality for its development in the reasonably near future.
(d) The requirements of this subsection are met if the evidence establishes that the municipality has developed and adopted a written fiscal plan and has established a definite policy, by resolution of the legislative body as set forth in section 3.1 of this chapter. The fiscal plan must show the following:
(1) The cost estimates of planned services to be furnished to the territory to be annexed. The plan must present itemized estimated costs for each municipal department or agency.
(2) The method or methods of financing the planned services. The plan must explain how specific and detailed expenses will be funded and must indicate the taxes, grants, and other funding to be used.
(3) The plan for the organization and extension of services. The plan must detail the specific services that will be provided and the dates the services will begin.
(4) That planned services of a noncapital nature, including police protection, fire protection, street and road maintenance, and other noncapital services normally provided within the corporate boundaries, will be provided to the annexed territory within one (1) year after the effective date of annexation and that they will be
provided in a manner equivalent in standard and scope to those
noncapital services provided to areas within the corporate
boundaries regardless of similar topography, patterns of land use,
and population density.
(5) That services of a capital improvement nature, including street
construction, street lighting, sewer facilities, water facilities, and
stormwater drainage facilities, will be provided to the annexed
territory within three (3) years after the effective date of the
annexation in the same manner as those services are provided to
areas within the corporate boundaries, regardless of similar
topography, patterns of land use, and population density, and in a
manner consistent with federal, state, and local laws, procedures,
and planning criteria.
(e) At the hearing under section 12 of this chapter, the court shall do
the following:
(1) Consider evidence on the conditions listed in subdivision (2).
(2) Order a proposed annexation not to take place if the court finds
that all of the conditions set forth in clauses (A) through (D) and,
if applicable, clause (E) exist in the territory proposed to be
annexed:
(A) The following services are adequately furnished by a
provider other than the municipality seeking the annexation:
(i) Police and fire protection.
(ii) Street and road maintenance.
(B) The annexation will have a significant financial impact on
the residents or owners of land.
(C) The annexation is not in the best interests of the owners of
land in the territory proposed to be annexed as set forth in
subsection (f).
(D) One (1) of the following opposes the annexation:
(i) At least sixty-five percent (65%) of the owners of land in
the territory proposed to be annexed.
(ii) The owners of more than seventy-five percent (75%) in
assessed valuation of the land in the territory proposed to be
annexed.
Evidence of opposition may be expressed by any owner of land
in the territory proposed to be annexed.
(E) This clause applies only to an annexation in which eighty
percent (80%) of the boundary of the territory proposed to be
annexed is contiguous to the municipality and the territory
consists of not more than one hundred (100) parcels. At least
seventy-five percent (75%) of the owners of land in the territory
proposed to be annexed oppose the annexation as determined
under section 11(b) of this chapter.
(f) The municipality under subsection (e)(2)(C) bears the burden of
proving that the annexation is in the best interests of the owners of land
in the territory proposed to be annexed. In determining this issue, the
court may consider whether the municipality has extended sewer or
water services to the entire territory to be annexed:
(1) within the three (3) years preceding the date of the introduction
of the annexation ordinance; or
(2) under a contract in lieu of annexation entered into under
IC 36-4-3-21.
The court may not consider the provision of water services as a result
of an order by the Indiana utility regulatory commission to constitute
the provision of water services to the territory to be annexed.
(g) This subsection applies only to cities located in a county having
a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000)
(250,000) but less than three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000).
(270,000). However, this subsection does not apply if on April 1, 1993,
the entire boundary of the territory that is proposed to be annexed was
contiguous to territory that was within the boundaries of one (1) or
more municipalities. At the hearing under section 12 of this chapter,
the court shall do the following:
(1) Consider evidence on the conditions listed in subdivision (2).
(2) Order a proposed annexation not to take place if the court finds
that all of the following conditions exist in the territory proposed
to be annexed:
(A) The following services are adequately furnished by a
provider other than the municipality seeking the annexation:
(i) Police and fire protection.
(ii) Street and road maintenance.
(B) The annexation will have a significant financial impact on
the residents or owners of land.
(C) One (1) of the following opposes the annexation:
(i) A majority of the owners of land in the territory proposed
to be annexed.
(ii) The owners of more than seventy-five percent (75%) in
assessed valuation of the land in the territory proposed to be
annexed.
Evidence of opposition may be expressed by any owner of land
in the territory proposed to be annexed.
(h) The most recent:
(1) federal decennial census;
(2) federal special census;
(3) special tabulation; or
(4) corrected population count;
shall be used as evidence of resident population density for purposes of subsection (b)(2)(A), but this evidence may be rebutted by other evidence of population density.
(b) Notwithstanding any other law, if a city annexed territory before March 1, 1990, and the annexation proceedings included a technical failure to describe a public way that separates the annexed territory from the city, the annexation is legalized and declared valid.
(c) Notwithstanding any other law, if the redevelopment commission of a city adopted a declaratory resolution under IC 36-7-14-15 before March 1, 1990, for any of the annexed territory described in subsection (b), the declaratory resolution is legalized and declared valid. If the declaratory resolution designated any of the annexed territory as an allocation area under IC 36-7-14-39, the assessment date for purposes of determining the base assessed value of the economic development area for purposes of IC 36-7-14-39 is March 1, 1989.
(b) In a third class city, the city attorney is the head of the department of law.
(c) To be eligible to be appointed as the head of the department of law, a person must meet the following requirements:
(1) Be admitted to the practice of law in Indiana.
(2) Except as provided in subdivision (3), be a resident of the county in which the city is located.
(3) For a third class city located in a county having a population of less than
a county having a population of more than fifty-five seventy thousand
(55,000) (70,000) but less than sixty-five seventy thousand (65,000)
fifty (70,050) is exempt from:
(1) the requirements of section 7(a) of this chapter; and
(2) the requirements of section 7(b) of this chapter if the second or
third class city is within a county containing a consolidated city.
(1) amount of the transfer;
(2) funds involved;
(3) date of the transfer; and
(4) general purpose of the transfer.
(b) Except as provided in subsection (c), this subsection applies to a town having a population of more than five hundred (500) but less than two thousand (2,000). Notwithstanding IC 8-14-1 and IC 8-14-2, a town may transfer money distributed to the town from:
(1) the motor vehicle highway account under IC 8-14-1;
(2) the local road and street account under IC 8-14-2; or
(3) the:
(A) motor vehicle highway account under IC 8-14-1; and
(B) local road and street account under IC 8-14-2;
to any other town fund after the passage of an ordinance or a resolution by the town legislative body that specifies the amount of the transfer, the funds involved, the date of the transfer, and the general purpose of the transfer. However, the total amount of all money transferred by a town under this subsection may not exceed forty thousand dollars ($40,000).
(c) A:
(1) municipality located in a county having a population of more than
(2) town:
(A) located in a county having a population of more than
(B) having a population of less than one thousand (1,000);
may not transfer money under this section to or from a food and beverage tax receipts fund established under IC 6-9.
(1) more than one hundred
(2) more than one hundred
the legislative bodies of that county and of the city having the largest population in that county may establish by identical ordinances a metropolitan plan commission as a department of county government. These ordinances must specify the legal name of the commission for purposes of section 404(a) of this chapter.
(b) AREA. There may be established in each county an area planning department in the county government, having:
(1) an area plan commission;
(2) an area board of zoning appeals;
(3) an executive director; and
(4) such staff as the area plan commission considers necessary.
Each municipality and each county desiring to participate in the establishment of a planning department may adopt an ordinance adopting the area planning law, fix a date for the establishment of the planning department, and provide for the appointment of its representatives to the commission. When a municipality or a county adopts such an ordinance, it shall certify a copy of
(c) METRO. A metropolitan development commission is established in the department of metropolitan development of the consolidated city. The legislative body of the consolidated city may adopt ordinances to regulate the following:
(1) The time that the commission holds its meetings.
(2) The voting procedures of the commission.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(b) ADVISORY.AREA. Notwithstanding sections 918.2, 918.4, and 918.5 of this chapter, a zoning or subdivision control ordinance shall require that the board of zoning appeals submit any of the following petitions to the legislative body for approval or disapproval:
(1) Special exceptions.
(2) Special uses.
(3) Use variances.
(c) ADVISORY.AREA. The board of zoning appeals shall file a petition under this section with the clerk of the legislative body with:
(1) a favorable recommendation;
(2) an unfavorable recommendation; or
(3) no recommendation.
(d) ADVISORY.AREA. The legislative body shall give notice under IC 5-14-1.5-5 of its intention to consider the petition at its first regular meeting after the board of zoning appeals files its recommendation.
(e) ADVISORY.AREA. A petition is granted or denied when the legislative body votes on the petition as follows:
(1) In a county described in subsection (a)(1), the legislative body shall vote on the petition within ninety (90) days after the board of zoning appeals makes its recommendation. If the legislative body does not vote to deny the petition within ninety (90) days, the petition is considered approved.
(2) In a county described in subsection (a)(2), the legislative body shall vote on the petition within sixty (60) days after the board of zoning appeals makes its recommendations. If the legislative body does not vote to deny the petition within sixty (60) days, the petition is approved.
(f) ADVISORY.AREA. If the legislative body approves a petition, it must make the determination in writing as required under section 918.2, 918.4, or 918.5 of this chapter or as required by the zoning ordinance.
having a population of more than twenty thousand three nine hundred
(20,300) (20,900) but less than twenty twenty-one thousand five
hundred (20,500). (21,000).
(b) ADVISORY_AREA. For purposes of this section, urban areas
include all lands and lots within the corporate boundaries of a
municipality, any other lands or lots used for residential purposes
where there are at least eight (8) residences within any quarter mile
square area, and other lands or lots that have been or are planned for
residential areas contiguous to the municipality.
(c) ADVISORY_AREA. This chapter does not authorize an
ordinance or action of a plan commission that would prevent, outside
of urban areas, the complete use and alienation of any mineral
resources or forests by the owner or alienee of them.
(b) ADVISORY. This section applies to a plan commission operating under a joinder agreement in a county:
(1)
(2) containing:
(A) a township having a population of more than
(B) a township having a population of more than nine thousand (9,000) but less than fifteen thousand (15,000).
(c) ADVISORY. Notwithstanding section 1210 of this chapter, a plan commission described in subsection (b) shall have nine (9) members as follows:
(1) Four (4) members who are residents of the municipality, to be appointed for four (4) year terms by the executive of the municipality.
(2) Three (3) members who are residents of the municipality, to be appointed for four (4) year terms by the legislative body of the municipality.
(3) Two (2) members who are residents of the township, to be appointed for four (4) year terms by the township executive with the approval of the township legislative body.
(d) The joinder agreement expires if the municipality annexes the entire area of a township described in subsection (b)(2).
(e) A joinder agreement under this section may be terminated if:
(1) the municipality adopts an ordinance terminating the joinder agreement;
(2) before adopting the ordinance under subdivision (1), the municipality conducts a public hearing on the issue of terminating the joinder agreement; and
(3) the executive of the municipality provides written notice to the township executive of the township subject to the joinder agreement that states the reason for the municipality's termination of the joinder agreement.
(1) knowledge and experience regarding affairs in the joint district;
(2) awareness of the social, economic, agricultural, and industrial conditions of the joint district; and
(3) an interest in the development of the joint district.
(b) A challenge to the appointment of a member based on the qualifications described in subsection (a) must be filed within thirty (30) days after the appointment. The challenge may be filed in the circuit court of any county that contains the entire joint district or any part of the joint district.
(c) Except as provided in subsection (d), a member must be a resident of a county where a part of the joint district is located or reside within ten (10) miles of the borders of the district.
(d) In a joint district that contains all or part of a county having a population of more than
(1) More than
(2) More than nineteen thousand
(3) More than ten thousand seven hundred (10,700) but less than twelve thousand (12,000).
(1) A county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(3) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(b) The ordinance may provide qualifications for members of the commission, but members must be residents of the unit who are interested in the preservation and development of historic areas. The members of the commission should include professionals in the disciplines of architectural history, planning, and other disciplines related to historic preservation, to the extent that those professionals are available in the community. The ordinance may also provide for the appointment of advisory members that the legislative body considers appropriate.
(c) The ordinance may:
(1) designate an officer or employee of the unit to act as
administrator;
(2) permit the commission to appoint an administrator who shall
serve without compensation except reasonable expenses incurred
in the performance of the administrator's duties; or
(3) provide that the commission act without the services of an
administrator.
(d) Members of the commission shall serve without compensation
except for reasonable expenses incurred in the performance of their
duties.
(e) The commission shall elect from its membership a chairman and
vice chairman, who shall serve for one (1) year and may be reelected.
(f) The commission shall adopt rules consistent with this chapter for
the transaction of its business. The rules must include the time and
place of regular meetings and a procedure for the calling of special
meetings. All meetings of the commission must be open to the public,
and a public record of the commission's resolutions, proceedings, and
actions must be kept. If the commission has an administrator, the
administrator shall act as the commission's secretary, otherwise, the
commission shall elect a secretary from its membership.
(g) The commission shall hold regular meetings, at least monthly,
except when it has no business pending.
(h) A final decision of the commission is subject to judicial review
under IC 36-7-4 as if it were a final decision of a board of zoning
appeals.
(b) Not more than two (2) working days after declaring a building or structure to be under interim protection under this section, the commission shall, by personal delivery or first class mail, provide the owner or occupant of the building or structure with a written notice of the declaration. The written notice must:
(1) cite the authority of the commission to put the building or structure under interim protection under this section;
(2) explain the effect of putting the building or structure under interim protection; and
(3) indicate that the interim protection is temporary.
(c) A building or structure put under interim protection under subsection (a) remains under interim protection until:
(1) in a county other than a county described in subdivision (2), the map is:
(A) submitted to; and
(B) approved in an ordinance or rejected by;
the legislative body of the unit; or
(2) in a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty thousand
(A) thirty (30) days after the building or structure is declared to be under interim protection; or
(B) the date the map is:
(i) submitted to; and
(ii) approved in an ordinance or rejected by;
the legislative body of the unit.
(d) While a building or structure is under interim protection under this section:
(1) the building or structure may not be demolished or moved; and
(2) the exterior appearance of the building or structure may not be conspicuously changed by:
(A) addition;
(B) reconstruction; or
(C) alteration.
(b) Notwithstanding any other provision, in the case of a building or structure owned by a political subdivision that is classified by a commission as historic and for which the classification is approved by the legislative body of the unit that established the commission, the commission may remove the historic classification of the building or structure without the adoption of an ordinance by the legislative body of the unit if the commission determines that removal of the classification is in the best interest of the unit and the political subdivision.
(1) more than one hundred
(130,000); (138,000);
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but
less than three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000);
(270,000); or
(3) more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four
hundred thousand (400,000);
the executive of the municipality may submit an application to an
advisory commission on industrial development requesting that an area
within the municipality be designated as a district.
(b) After approval by ordinance or resolution of the legislative body
of a county, the executive of the county may submit an application to
an advisory commission on industrial development requesting that an
area within the county, but not within a municipality, be designated as
a district. However, in a county having a population of more than one
hundred eighteen fifteen thousand (118,000) (115,000) but less than
one hundred twenty twenty-five thousand (120,000), (125,000), the
legislative body of the county may request that an area within the
county be designated as a district even if the area is within a
municipality.
(b) An area is added to and becomes part of a district described in subsection (a) if the area consists of property that:
(1) is located in a city having a population of more than
(2) experienced a loss of at least three hundred (300) jobs during the calendar year ending December 31, 2001.
(c) After the addition of property to a district described in subsection (a) under this section, the gross retail base period amount determined under section 2.4 of this chapter for the district before the addition of the property to the district under this section shall be increased by an amount equal to:
(1) the aggregate amount of state gross retail and use taxes remitted:
(A) under IC 6-2.5 by the businesses operating in the area added to the district under subsection (b); and
(B) during the period beginning after December 31, 2001, and ending before February 1, 2002; multiplied by
(2) twelve (12).
(d) After the addition of property to a district described in subsection (a) under this section, the income tax base period amount determined under section 3.2 of this chapter for the district before the addition of the property to the district under this section shall be increased by an amount equal to:
(1) the aggregate amount of state and local income taxes paid:
(A) by employees employed in the area added to the district under subsection (b) with respect to wages and salary earned for work in the area added; and
(B) during the period beginning after December 31, 2001, and ending before February 1, 2002; multiplied by
(2) twelve (12).
(e) The addition of property to a district under this section does not require adoption of an ordinance, review by the budget committee, or approval of the budget agency under section 10.5 of this chapter.
(b) For an area located in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(1) The area contains a building or buildings:
(A) with at least one million (1,000,000) square feet of usable interior floor space; and
(B) that is or are vacant or will become vacant due to the relocation of an employer.
(2) At least one thousand (1,000) fewer persons are employed in the area than were employed in the area during the year that is ten
(10) years previous to the current year.
(3) There are significant obstacles to redevelopment of the area
due to any of the following problems:
(A) Obsolete or inefficient buildings.
(B) Aging infrastructure or inefficient utility services.
(C) Utility relocation requirements.
(D) Transportation or access problems.
(E) Topographical obstacles to redevelopment.
(F) Environmental contamination.
(4) The unit has expended, appropriated, pooled, set aside, or
pledged at least one hundred thousand dollars ($100,000) for
purposes of addressing the redevelopment obstacles described in
subdivision (3).
(5) The area is located in a county having a population of more
than one hundred twenty thirty-five thousand (120,000) (135,000)
but less than one hundred thirty thirty-eight thousand (130,000).
(138,000).
(c) For a county having a population of more than one hundred
eighteen fifteen thousand (118,000) (115,000) but less than one
hundred twenty twenty-five thousand (120,000), (125,000), an
advisory commission may adopt a resolution designating not more than
three (3) areas as districts. An advisory commission may designate an
area as a district only after finding the following:
(1) The area meets at least one (1) of the following conditions:
(A) The area meets the following conditions:
(i) The area contains a building with at least seven hundred
ninety thousand (790,000) square feet.
(ii) At least eight hundred (800) fewer people are employed in
the area than were employed in the area during the year that is
fifteen (15) years previous to the current year.
(iii) The area is located in or is adjacent to an industrial park.
(B) The area meets the following conditions:
(i) The area contains a building with at least three hundred
eighty-six thousand (386,000) square feet.
(ii) At least four hundred (400) fewer people are employed in
the area than were employed in the area during the year that is
fifteen (15) years previous to the current year.
(iii) The area is located in or is adjacent to an industrial park.
(C) The area meets the following conditions:
(i) The area contains a building with at least one million
(1,000,000) square feet.
(ii) At least seven hundred (700) fewer people are employed
in the area than were employed in the area on January 1, 2008.
(2) There are significant obstacles to redevelopment of the area
due to any of the following problems:
(A) Obsolete or inefficient buildings.
(B) Aging infrastructure or inefficient utility services.
(C) Utility relocation requirements.
(D) Transportation or access problems.
(E) Topographical obstacles to redevelopment.
(F) Environmental contamination.
(3) The area is located in a county having a population of more
than one hundred eighteen fifteen thousand (118,000) (115,000)
but less than one hundred twenty twenty-five thousand (120,000).
(125,000).
(d) For an area located in a county having a population of more than
two hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two
hundred seventy thousand (300,000), (270,000), an advisory
commission may adopt a resolution designating a particular area as a
district only after finding all of the following:
(1) The area contains a building or buildings:
(A) with at least one million five hundred thousand (1,500,000)
square feet of usable interior floor space; and
(B) that is or are vacant or will become vacant.
(2) At least eighteen thousand (18,000) fewer persons are
employed in the area at the time of application than were employed
in the area before the time of application.
(3) There are significant obstacles to redevelopment of the area
due to any of the following problems:
(A) Obsolete or inefficient buildings.
(B) Aging infrastructure or inefficient utility services.
(C) Utility relocation requirements.
(D) Transportation or access problems.
(E) Topographical obstacles to redevelopment.
(F) Environmental contamination.
(4) The unit has expended, appropriated, pooled, set aside, or
pledged at least one hundred thousand dollars ($100,000) for
purposes of addressing the redevelopment obstacles described in
subdivision (3).
(5) The area is located in a county having a population of more
than two hundred fifty thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than
three two hundred seventy thousand (300,000). (270,000).
(e) For an area located in a county having a population of more than
three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand
(400,000), an advisory commission may adopt a resolution designating
a particular area as a district only after finding all of the following:
(1) The area contains a building or buildings:
(A) with at least eight hundred thousand (800,000) gross square
feet; and
(B) having leasable floor space, at least fifty percent (50%) of
which is or will become vacant.
(2) There are significant obstacles to redevelopment of the area
due to any of the following problems:
(A) Obsolete or inefficient buildings as evidenced by a decline
of at least seventy-five percent (75%) in their assessed valuation
during the preceding ten (10) years.
(B) Transportation or access problems.
(C) Environmental contamination.
(3) At least four hundred (400) fewer persons are employed in the
area than were employed in the area during the year that is fifteen
(15) years previous to the current year.
(4) The area has been designated as an economic development
target area under IC 6-1.1-12.1-7.
(5) The unit has appropriated, pooled, set aside, or pledged at least
two hundred fifty thousand dollars ($250,000) for purposes of
addressing the redevelopment obstacles described in subdivision
(2).
(6) The area is located in a county having a population of more
than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred
thousand (400,000).
(f) The advisory commission, or the county or municipal legislative
body, in the case of a district designated under section 10.5 of this
chapter, shall designate the duration of the district. However, a district
must terminate not later than fifteen (15) years after the income tax
incremental amount or gross retail incremental amount is first allocated
to the district.
(g) Upon adoption of a resolution designating a district, the advisory
commission shall:
(1) publish notice of the adoption and substance of the resolution
in accordance with IC 5-3-1; and
(2) file the following information with each taxing unit in the
county where the district is located:
(A) A copy of the notice required by subdivision (1).
(B) A statement disclosing the impact of the district, including
the following:
(i) The estimated economic benefits and costs incurred by the
district, as measured by increased employment and anticipated
growth of property assessed values.
(ii) The anticipated impact on tax revenues of each taxing unit.
The notice must state the general boundaries of the district.
(h) Upon completion of the actions required by subsection (g), the
advisory commission shall submit the resolution to the budget
committee for review and recommendation to the budget agency. If the
budget agency fails to take action on a resolution designating a district
within one hundred twenty (120) days after the date that the resolution
is submitted to the budget committee, the designation of the district by
the resolution is considered approved.
(i) When considering a resolution, the budget committee and the
budget agency must make the following findings:
(1) The area to be designated as a district meets the conditions
necessary for designation as a district.
(2) The designation of the district will benefit the people of Indiana
by protecting or increasing state and local tax bases and tax
revenues for at least the duration of the district.
(j) The income tax incremental amount and the gross retail
incremental amount may not be allocated to the district until the
resolution is approved under this section.
(b) In adopting a declaratory resolution under section 15 of this chapter, a redevelopment commission may include a provision stating that the redevelopment project area is considered to include one (1) or more additional areas outside the boundaries of the redevelopment project area if the redevelopment commission makes the following findings and the requirements of subsection (c) are met:
(1) One (1) or more taxpayers presently located within the boundaries of the redevelopment project area are expected within one (1) year to relocate all or part of their operations outside the boundaries of the redevelopment project area and have expressed an interest in relocating all or part of their operations within the boundaries of an additional area.
(2) The relocation described in subdivision (1) will contribute to the continuation of the conditions described in IC 36-7-1-3 in the redevelopment project area.
(3) For purposes of this section, it will be of public utility and benefit to include the additional areas as part of the redevelopment project area.
(c) Each additional area must be designated by the redevelopment commission as a redevelopment project area or an economic development area under this chapter.
(d) Notwithstanding section 3 of this chapter, the additional areas shall be considered to be a part of the redevelopment special taxing district under the jurisdiction of the redevelopment commission. Any excess property taxes that the commission has determined may be paid to taxing units under section 39(b)(4) of this chapter shall be paid to the taxing units from which the excess property taxes were derived. All powers of the redevelopment commission authorized under this chapter may be exercised by the redevelopment commission in additional areas under its jurisdiction.
(e) The declaratory resolution must include a statement of the general boundaries of each additional area. However, it is sufficient to describe those boundaries by location in relation to public ways, streams, or otherwise, as determined by the commissioners.
(f) The declaratory resolution may include a provision with respect to the allocation and distribution of property taxes with respect to one (1) or more of the additional areas in the manner provided in section 39 of this chapter. If the redevelopment commission includes such a provision in the resolution, allocation areas in the redevelopment project area and in the additional areas considered to be part of the redevelopment project area shall be considered a single allocation area for purposes of this chapter.
(g) The additional areas must be located within the same county as the redevelopment project area but are not otherwise required to be within the jurisdiction of the redevelopment commission, if the redevelopment commission obtains the consent by ordinance of:
(1) the county legislative body, for each additional area located within the unincorporated part of the county; or
(2) the legislative body of the city or town affected, for each additional area located within a city or town.
In granting its consent, the legislative body shall approve the plan of development or redevelopment relating to the additional area.
(h) A declaratory resolution previously adopted may be amended to include a provision to include additional areas as set forth in this section and an allocation provision under section 39 of this chapter with respect to one (1) or more of the additional areas in accordance with sections 15, 16, and 17 of this chapter.
(i) The redevelopment commission may amend the allocation provision of a declaratory resolution in accordance with sections 15, 16, and 17 of this chapter to change the assessment date that determines the base assessed value of property in the allocation area to any assessment date following the effective date of the allocation provision of the declaratory resolution. Such a change may relate to the assessment date that determines the base assessed value of that portion of the allocation area that is located in the redevelopment project area alone, that portion of the allocation area that is located in an additional area alone, or the entire allocation area.
(b) As used in this section, "designated taxpayer" means any taxpayer designated by the commission in a declaratory resolution adopted or amended under section 15 or 17.5 of this chapter and with respect to which the commission finds that taxes to be derived from the taxpayer's depreciable personal property in the allocation area, in excess of the taxes attributable to the base assessed value of that personal property, are reasonably expected to exceed in one (1) or more future years the taxes to be derived from the taxpayer's real property in the allocation area in excess of the taxes attributable to the base assessed value of that real property.
(c) The allocation provision of a declaratory resolution may modify the definition of "property taxes" under section 39(a) of this chapter to include taxes imposed under IC 6-1.1 on the depreciable personal property of designated taxpayers, in accordance with the procedures and limitations set forth in this section and section 39 of this chapter. If such a modification is included in the resolution for purposes of section 39 of this chapter, the term "base assessed value" with respect to the depreciable personal property of designated taxpayers means the net assessed value of all the depreciable personal property as finally determined for the assessment date immediately preceding:
(1) the effective date of the modification, for modifications adopted before July 1, 1995; and
(2) the adoption date of the modification for modifications adopted after June 30, 1995;
as adjusted under section 39(h) of this chapter.
to the following:
(1) A city having a population of more than seventy-five eighty
thousand (75,000) five hundred (80,500) but less than ninety one
hundred thousand (90,000). (100,000).
(2) A city having a population of more than one hundred five
thousand (105,000) (100,000) but less than one hundred twenty ten
thousand (120,000). (110,000).
(3) A city having a population of more than one hundred fifty
thousand (150,000) but less than five hundred thousand (500,000).
(4) A city having a population of more than one hundred twenty
ten thousand (120,000) (110,000) but less than one hundred fifty
thousand (150,000).
(1) A city having a population of more than
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(1) owned by the city, the county, a school corporation, or a board under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8, IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11, and used by a professional sports franchise for practice or competitive sporting events;
(2) owned by the city, the county, or a board under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8, IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11, and used as one (1) of the following:
(A) A facility used principally for convention or tourism related events serving national or regional markets.
(B) An airport.
(C) A museum.
(D) A zoo.
(E) A facility used for public attractions of national significance.
(F) A performing arts venue.
(G) A county courthouse registered on the National Register of Historic Places; or
(3) a hotel.
Notwithstanding section 9 of this chapter or any other law, a designating body may by resolution approve the expansion of a professional sports and convention development area after June 30, 2009, to include a hotel designated by the designating body. A resolution for such an expansion must be reviewed by the budget committee and approved by the budget agency in the same manner as a resolution establishing a professional sports and convention development area is reviewed and approved. A facility may not include a private golf course or related improvements. The tax area may include only facilities described in this section and any parcel of land on which a facility is located. An area may contain noncontiguous tracts of land within the city, county, or school corporation.
(b) Except for a tax area that is located in a city having a population of:
(1) more than one hundred fifty thousand (150,000) but less than five hundred thousand (500,000); or
(2) more than
a tax area must include at least one (1) facility described in subsection (a)(1).
(c) A tax area may contain other facilities not owned by the designating body if:
(1) the facility is owned by a city, the county, a school corporation, or a board established under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8, IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11; and
(2) an agreement exists between the designating body and the owner of the facility specifying the distribution and uses of the covered taxes to be allocated under this chapter.
(d) This subsection applies to all tax areas located in a county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000). The facilities located at an Indiana University-Purdue University regional campus are added to the tax area designated by the county. The maximum amount of covered taxes that may be captured in all tax areas located in the county is three million dollars ($3,000,000) per year, regardless of the designating body that established the tax area. The county option income taxes imposed under IC 6-3.5 that are captured must be counted first toward this maximum.
[EFFECTIVE APRIL 1, 2012]: Sec. 9. (a) A tax area must be initially
established by resolution:
(1) except as provided in subdivision (2) before July 1, 1999; or
(2) before January 1, 2013, in the case of:
(A) a second class city;
(B) the city of Marion; or
(C) the city of Westfield;
according to the procedures set forth for the establishment of an
economic development area under IC 36-7-14. Before May 15, 2005,
a tax area established before January 1, 2005, may be changed or the
terms governing the tax area revised in the same manner as the
establishment of the initial tax area. After May 14, 2005, a tax area
established before January 1, 2005, may not be changed and the terms
governing a tax area may not be revised. Only one (1) tax area may be
created in each county.
(b) In establishing the tax area, the designating body must make the
following findings instead of the findings required for the
establishment of economic development areas:
(1) Except for a tax area in a city having a population of:
(A) more than one hundred fifty thousand (150,000) but less
than five hundred thousand (500,000); or
(B) more than ninety eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less
than one hundred five eighty thousand (105,000); four hundred
(80,400);
there is a capital improvement that will be undertaken or has been
undertaken in the tax area for a facility that is used by a
professional sports franchise for practice or competitive sporting
events. A tax area to which this subdivision applies may also
include a capital improvement that will be undertaken or has been
undertaken in the tax area for a facility that is used for any purpose
specified in section 8(a)(2) of this chapter.
(2) For a tax area in a city having a population of more than one
hundred fifty thousand (150,000) but less than five hundred
thousand (500,000), there is a capital improvement that will be
undertaken or has been undertaken in the tax area for a facility that
is used for any purpose specified in section 8(a) of this chapter.
(3) For a tax area in a city having a population of more than ninety
eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five
eighty thousand (105,000), four hundred (80,400), there is a
capital improvement that will be undertaken or has been
undertaken in the tax area for a facility that is used for any purpose
specified in section 8(a)(2) of this chapter.
(4) The capital improvement that will be undertaken or that has been undertaken in the tax area will benefit the public health and welfare and will be of public utility and benefit.
(5) The capital improvement that will be undertaken or that has been undertaken in the tax area will protect or increase state and local tax bases and tax revenues.
(c) The tax area established under this chapter is a special taxing district authorized by the general assembly to enable the designating body to provide special benefits to taxpayers in the tax area by promoting economic development that is of public use and benefit.
(1) The first two million six hundred thousand dollars ($2,600,000) shall be transferred to the county treasurer for deposit in the supplemental coliseum improvement fund.
(2) The remaining amount shall be transferred to the treasurer of the joint county-city capital improvement board in the county.
The resolution must provide the tax area terminates not later than December 31, 2027.
(b) In addition to subsection (a), all of the salary, wages, bonuses, and other compensation that are:
(1) paid during a taxable year to a professional athlete for professional athletic services;
(2) taxable in Indiana; and
(3) earned in the tax area;
shall be allocated to the tax area if the professional athlete is a member of a team that plays the majority of the professional athletic events that the team plays in Indiana in the tax area.
(c) For a tax area that is:
(1) not located in a county having a population of more than three hundred thousand (300,000) but less than four hundred thousand (400,000); and
(2) not located in a city having a population of more than one
hundred five thousand (105,000) and (100,000) but less than one
hundred twenty ten thousand (120,000); (110,000);
the total amount of state revenue captured by the tax area may not
exceed five dollars ($5) per resident of the city or county per year for
twenty (20) consecutive years.
(d) For a tax area that is located in a city having a population of more
than one hundred five thousand (105,000) and (100,000) but less than
one hundred twenty ten thousand (120,000), (110,000), the total
amount of state revenue captured by the tax area may not exceed six
dollars and fifty cents ($6.50) per resident of the city per year for
twenty (20) consecutive years.
(e) The resolution establishing the tax area must designate the facility
or proposed facility and the facility site for which the tax area is
established.
(f) The department may adopt rules under IC 4-22-2 and guidelines
to govern the allocation of covered taxes to a tax area.
(1) Except in a tax area in a city having a population of:
(A) more than one hundred fifty thousand (150,000) but less than five hundred thousand (500,000); or
(B) more than
a capital improvement that will construct or equip a facility owned by the city, the county, a school corporation, or a board under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8, IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11 and used by a professional sports franchise for practice or competitive sporting events. In a tax area to which this subdivision applies, funds may also be used for a capital improvement that will construct or equip a facility owned by the city, the county, or a board under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8, IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11 and used for any purpose specified in section 8(a)(2) of this chapter.
(2) In a city having a population of more than one hundred fifty thousand (150,000) but less than five hundred thousand (500,000), a capital improvement that will construct or equip a facility owned by the city, the county, a school corporation, or a board under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8, IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11 and used for any purpose specified in section 8(a) of this chapter.
(3) In a city having a population of more than
thousand (90,000) (80,000) but less than one hundred five eighty
thousand (105,000), four hundred (80,400), a capital
improvement that will construct or equip a facility owned by the
city, the county, or a board under IC 36-9-13, IC 36-10-8,
IC 36-10-10, or IC 36-10-11 and used for any purpose specified in
section 8(a)(1) or 8(a)(2) of this chapter.
(4) The financing or refinancing of a capital improvement
described in subdivision (1), (2), or (3) or the payment of lease
payments for a capital improvement described in subdivision (1),
(2), or (3).
(1) A county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(3) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(A) the fiscal body of the county has adopted an ordinance under IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) providing that the county is joining the development authority; and
(B) the fiscal body of the city described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) has adopted an ordinance under IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) providing that the city is joining the development authority.
(b) Except as provided in subsections (e), (f), and (h), the development board is composed of the following seven (7) members:
(1) Two (2) members appointed by the governor. One (1) of the members appointed by the governor under this subdivision must be an individual nominated under subsection (d). The members appointed by the governor under this subdivision serve at the pleasure of the governor.
(2) The following members from a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000):
(A) One (1) member appointed by the mayor of the largest city in the county in which a riverboat is located.
(B) One (1) member appointed by the mayor of the second largest city in the county in which a riverboat is located.
(C) One (1) member appointed by the mayor of the third largest city in the county in which a riverboat is located.
(D) One (1) member appointed jointly by the county executive and the county fiscal body. A member appointed under this clause may not reside in a city described in clause (A), (B), or (C).
(3) One (1) member appointed jointly by the county executive and county fiscal body of a county having a population of more than one hundred
(c) A member appointed to the development board must have knowledge and at least five (5) years professional work experience in at least one (1) of the following:
(1) Rail transportation or air transportation.
(2) Regional economic development.
(3) Business or finance.
(d) The mayor of the largest city in a county having a population of more than one hundred
of the largest and the second largest city in the county at the expiration
of a member's term.
(e) A county having a population of more than one hundred ten
eleven thousand (110,000) (111,000) but less than one hundred fifteen
thousand (115,000) shall be an eligible county participating in the
development authority if the fiscal body of the county adopts an
ordinance before September 15, 2006, providing that the county is
joining the development authority and the fiscal body of a city that is
located in the county and that has a population of more than thirty-two
thirty-one thousand eight hundred (32,800) (31,000) but less than
thirty-three thirty-one thousand (33,000) five hundred (31,500)
adopts an ordinance before September 15, 2006, providing that the city
is joining the development authority. Notwithstanding subsection (b),
if ordinances are adopted under this subsection and the county becomes
an eligible county participating in the development authority:
(1) the development board shall be composed of nine (9) members
rather than seven (7) members; and
(2) the additional two (2) members shall be appointed in the
following manner:
(A) One (1) additional member shall be appointed by the
governor and shall serve at the pleasure of the governor. The
member appointed under this clause must be an individual
nominated under subsection (f).
(B) One (1) additional member shall be appointed jointly by the
county executive and county fiscal body.
(f) This subsection applies only if the county described in subsection
(e) is an eligible county participating in the development authority. The
mayor of the largest city in the county described in subsection (e) shall
nominate three (3) residents of the county for appointment to the
development board. The governor's initial appointment under
subsection (e)(2)(A) must be an individual nominated by the mayor. At
the expiration of the member's term, the mayor of the second largest
city in the county described in subsection (e) shall nominate three (3)
residents of the county for appointment to the development board. The
governor's second appointment under subsection (e)(2)(A) must be an
individual nominated by the mayor. Thereafter, the authority to
nominate the three (3) individuals from among whom the governor
shall make an appointment under subsection (e)(2)(A) shall alternate
between the mayors of the largest and the second largest city in the
county at the expiration of a member's term.
(g) An individual or entity required to make an appointment under
subsection (b) or nominations under subsection (d) must make the
initial appointment before September 1, 2005, or the initial nomination
before August 15, 2005. If an individual or entity does not make an
initial appointment under subsection (b) before September 1, 2005, or
the initial nominations required under subsection (d) before September
1, 2005, the governor shall instead make the initial appointment.
(h) Subsection (i) applies only to municipalities located in a county
that:
(1) has a population of more than one hundred forty-five fifty
thousand (145,000) (150,000) but less than one hundred forty-eight
seventy thousand (148,000); (170,000); and
(2) was a member of the development authority on January 1,
2009, and subsequently ceases to be a member of the development
authority.
(i) If the fiscal bodies of at least two (2) municipalities subject to this
subsection adopt ordinances to become members of the development
authority, those municipalities shall become members of the
development authority. If two (2) or more municipalities become
members of the development authority under this subsection, the fiscal
bodies of the municipalities that become members of the development
authority shall jointly appoint one (1) member of the development
board who shall serve in place of the member described in subsection
(b)(3). A municipality that becomes a member of the development
authority under this subsection is considered an eligible municipality
for purposes of this article.
(b) This subsection applies only if:
(1) the fiscal body of the county described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) has adopted an ordinance under IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) providing that the county is joining the development authority;
(2) the fiscal body of the city described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) has adopted an ordinance under IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) providing that the city is joining the development authority; and
(3) the county described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) is an eligible county participating in the development authority.
Beginning in 2007, the fiscal officer of the county described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) shall transfer two million six hundred twenty-five thousand dollars ($2,625,000) each year to the development authority for deposit in the development authority fund established under section 1 of this chapter. Beginning in 2007, the fiscal officer of the city described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) shall transfer eight hundred seventy-five thousand dollars ($875,000) each year to the development authority for deposit in the development authority fund established under section 1 of this chapter.
(c) The following apply to the transfers required by subsections (a) and (b):
(1) Except for transfers of money described in subdivision (4)(D), the transfers shall be made without appropriation by the city or county fiscal body or approval by any other entity.
(2) Except as provided in subdivision (3), after December 31, 2005, each fiscal officer shall transfer eight hundred seventy-five thousand dollars ($875,000) to the development authority fund before the last business day of January, April, July, and October of each year. Food and beverage tax revenue deposited in the fund under IC 6-9-36-8 is in addition to the transfers required by this section.
(3) After December 31, 2006, the fiscal officer of the county described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) shall transfer six hundred fifty-six thousand two hundred fifty dollars ($656,250) to the development authority fund before the last business day of January, April, July, and October of each year. The county is not required to make any payments or transfers to the development authority covering any time before January 1, 2007. The fiscal officer of a city described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) shall transfer two hundred eighteen thousand seven hundred fifty dollars ($218,750) to the development authority fund before the last business day of January, April, July, and October of each year. The city is not required to make any payments or transfers to the development authority covering any time before January 1, 2007.
(4) The transfers shall be made from one (1) or more of the following:
(A) Riverboat admissions tax revenue received by the city or county, riverboat wagering tax revenue received by the city or county, or riverboat incentive payments received from a riverboat licensee by the city or county.
(B) Any county economic development income tax revenue received under IC 6-3.5-7 by the city or county.
(C) Any other local revenue other than property tax revenue received by the city or county.
(D) In the case of a county described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e) or a city described in IC 36-7.5-2-3(e), any money from the major moves construction fund that is distributed to the county or city under IC 8-14-16.
(1) full-time police officers hired or rehired after April 30, 1977, in all municipalities, or who converted their benefits under IC 19-1-17.8-7 (repealed September 1, 1981);
(2) full-time fully paid firefighters hired or rehired after April 30, 1977, or who converted their benefits under IC 19-1-36.5-7 (repealed September 1, 1981);
(3) a police matron hired or rehired after April 30, 1977, and before July 1, 1996, who is a member of a police department in a second or third class city on March 31, 1996;
(4) a park ranger who:
(A) completed at least the number of weeks of training at the Indiana law enforcement academy or a comparable law enforcement academy in another state that were required at the time the park ranger attended the Indiana law enforcement academy or the law enforcement academy in another state;
(B) graduated from the Indiana law enforcement academy or a comparable law enforcement academy in another state; and
(C) is employed by the parks department of a city having a population of more than one hundred
(5) a full-time fully paid firefighter who is covered by this chapter before the effective date of consolidation and becomes a member of the fire department of a consolidated city under IC 36-3-1-6.1, provided that the firefighter's service as a member of the fire
department of a consolidated city is considered active service
under this chapter;
(6) except as otherwise provided, a full-time fully paid firefighter
who is hired or rehired after the effective date of the consolidation
by a consolidated fire department established under IC 36-3-1-6.1;
(7) a full-time police officer who is covered by this chapter before
the effective date of consolidation and becomes a member of the
consolidated law enforcement department as part of the
consolidation under IC 36-3-1-5.1, provided that the officer's
service as a member of the consolidated law enforcement
department is considered active service under this chapter; and
(8) except as otherwise provided, a full-time police officer who is
hired or rehired after the effective date of the consolidation by a
consolidated law enforcement department established under
IC 36-3-1-5.1;
except as provided by section 7 of this chapter.
(1) a police officer; or
(2) a firefighter;
who is less than thirty-six (36) years of age and who passes the baseline statewide physical and mental examinations required under section 19 of this chapter shall be a member of the 1977 fund and is not a member of the 1925 fund, the 1937 fund, or the 1953 fund.
(b) A police officer or firefighter with service before May 1, 1977, who is hired or rehired after April 30, 1977, may receive credit under this chapter for service as a police officer or firefighter prior to entry into the 1977 fund if the employer who rehires the police officer or firefighter chooses to contribute to the 1977 fund the amount necessary to amortize the police officer's or firefighter's prior service liability over a period of not more than forty (40) years, the amount and the period to be determined by the PERF board. If the employer chooses to make the contributions, the police officer or firefighter is entitled to receive credit for the police officer's or firefighter's prior years of service without making contributions to the 1977 fund for that prior service. In no event may a police officer or firefighter receive credit for prior years of service if the police officer or firefighter is receiving a benefit or is entitled to receive a benefit in the future from any other public pension plan with respect to the prior years of service.
(c) Except as provided in section 18 of this chapter, a police officer
or firefighter is entitled to credit for all years of service after April 30,
1977, with the police or fire department of an employer covered by this
chapter.
(d) A police officer or firefighter with twenty (20) years of service
does not become a member of the 1977 fund and is not covered by this
chapter, if the police officer or firefighter:
(1) was hired before May 1, 1977;
(2) did not convert under IC 19-1-17.8-7 or IC 19-1-36.5-7 (both
of which were repealed September 1, 1981); and
(3) is rehired after April 30, 1977, by the same employer.
(e) A police officer or firefighter does not become a member of the
1977 fund and is not covered by this chapter if the police officer or
firefighter:
(1) was hired before May 1, 1977;
(2) did not convert under IC 19-1-17.8-7 or IC 19-1-36.5-7 (both
of which were repealed September 1, 1981);
(3) was rehired after April 30, 1977, but before February 1, 1979;
and
(4) was made, before February 1, 1979, a member of a 1925, 1937,
or 1953 fund.
(f) A police officer or firefighter does not become a member of the
1977 fund and is not covered by this chapter if the police officer or
firefighter:
(1) was hired by the police or fire department of a unit before May
1, 1977;
(2) did not convert under IC 19-1-17.8-7 or IC 19-1-36.5-7 (both
of which were repealed September 1, 1981);
(3) is rehired by the police or fire department of another unit after
December 31, 1981; and
(4) is made, by the fiscal body of the other unit after December 31,
1981, a member of a 1925, 1937, or 1953 fund of the other unit.
If the police officer or firefighter is made a member of a 1925, 1937, or
1953 fund, the police officer or firefighter is entitled to receive credit
for all the police officer's or firefighter's years of service, including
years before January 1, 1982.
(g) As used in this subsection, "emergency medical services" and
"emergency medical technician" have the meanings set forth in
IC 16-18-2-110 and IC 16-18-2-112. A firefighter who:
(1) is employed by a unit that is participating in the 1977 fund;
(2) was employed as an emergency medical technician by a
political subdivision wholly or partially within the department's
jurisdiction;
(3) was a member of the public employees' retirement fund during the employment described in subdivision (2); and
(4) ceased employment with the political subdivision and was hired by the unit's fire department due to the reorganization of emergency medical services within the department's jurisdiction;
shall participate in the 1977 fund. A firefighter who participates in the 1977 fund under this subsection is subject to sections 18 and 21 of this chapter.
(h) A police officer or firefighter does not become a member of the 1977 fund and is not covered by this chapter if the individual was appointed as:
(1) a fire chief under a waiver under IC 36-8-4-6(c); or
(2) a police chief under a waiver under IC 36-8-4-6.5(c);
unless the executive of the unit requests that the 1977 fund accept the individual in the 1977 fund and the individual previously was a member of the 1977 fund.
(i) A police matron hired or rehired after April 30, 1977, and before July 1, 1996, who is a member of a police department in a second or third class city on March 31, 1996, is a member of the 1977 fund.
(j) A park ranger who:
(1) completed at least the number of weeks of training at the Indiana law enforcement academy or a comparable law enforcement academy in another state that were required at the time the park ranger attended the Indiana law enforcement academy or the law enforcement academy in another state;
(2) graduated from the Indiana law enforcement academy or a comparable law enforcement academy in another state; and
(3) is employed by the parks department of a city having a population of more than one hundred
is a member of the fund.
(k) Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter, a police officer or firefighter:
(1) who is a member of the 1977 fund before a consolidation under IC 36-3-1-5.1 or IC 36-3-1-6.1;
(2) whose employer is consolidated into the consolidated law enforcement department or the fire department of a consolidated city under IC 36-3-1-5.1 or IC 36-3-1-6.1; and
(3) who, after the consolidation, becomes an employee of the consolidated law enforcement department or the consolidated fire department under IC 36-3-1-5.1 or IC 36-3-1-6.1;
is a member of the 1977 fund without meeting the requirements under sections 19 and 21 of this chapter.
(l) Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter, if:
(1) before a consolidation under IC 8-22-3-11.6, a police officer or firefighter provides law enforcement services or fire protection services for an entity in a consolidated city;
(2) the provision of those services is consolidated into the law enforcement department or fire department of a consolidated city; and
(3) after the consolidation, the police officer or firefighter becomes an employee of the consolidated law enforcement department or the consolidated fire department under IC 8-22-3-11.6;
the police officer or firefighter is a member of the 1977 fund without meeting the requirements under sections 19 and 21 of this chapter.
(m) A police officer or firefighter who is a member of the 1977 fund under subsection (k) or (l) may not be:
(1) retired for purposes of section 10 of this chapter; or
(2) disabled for purposes of section 12 of this chapter;
solely because of a change in employer under the consolidation.
(1) Increase the amount per meal by a percentage that does not exceed the percent of increase in the United States Department of Labor Consumer Price Index during the year preceding the year in which an increase is established.
(2) Increase the amount per meal above the amount determined under subdivision (1) if the sheriff furnishes to the state examiner sufficient documentation to prove that the sheriff cannot provide meals at the amount per meal that is determined under subdivision (1).
The amount must be fixed by April 15 each year and takes effect immediately upon approval. The allowance may not exceed two dollars ($2) per person per meal. The allowance shall be paid out of the general fund of the county after the sheriff submits to the county executive an itemized statement, under oath, showing the names of the prisoners, the date that each was imprisoned in the county jail, and the number of meals served to each prisoner.
(b) Notwithstanding subsection (a), IC 36-2-13-2.5(b)(4) through IC 36-2-13-2.5(b)(5), and IC 36-2-13-2.8(b), this subsection applies to a county having a population of:
(1) more than one hundred
(2) more than three hundred thousand (300,000).
A county shall feed the county prisoners through an appropriation in the usual manner by the county fiscal body. The appropriation shall be expended by the sheriff under the direction of the county executive. If a county has a population of less than four hundred thousand (400,000), an accounting of the expenditures must be filed monthly with the county auditor by the fifth day of the month following the expenditure. If a county has a population of four hundred thousand (400,000) or more, an accounting of the expenditures must be filed with the county auditor on the first Monday of January and the first Monday of July of each year. Neither the sheriff nor the sheriff's officers, deputies, and employees may make a profit as a result of the appropriation.
(1) A county having a consolidated city.
(2) A county having a population of more than one hundred
(3)
However, sections 9.5, 15, 16, 17, and 18 of this chapter apply only to a county having a consolidated city.
within the district. The property tax rate for that levy may not exceed
five cents ($0.05) on each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed
valuation.
(b) This subsection applies to a county having a consolidated city.
The county fiscal body may elect to fund the operation of the district
from part of the certified distribution, if any, that the county is to
receive during a particular calendar year under IC 6-3.5-6-17. To make
such an election, the county fiscal body must adopt an ordinance before
September 1 of the immediately preceding calendar year. The county
fiscal body must specify in the ordinance the amount of the certified
distribution that is to be used to fund the operation of the district. If the
county fiscal body adopts such an ordinance, it shall immediately send
a copy of the ordinance to the county auditor.
(c) Subject to subsections (d), (e), and (f), if an ordinance or
resolution is adopted changing the territory covered by the district or
the number of public agencies served by the district, the department of
local government finance shall, for property taxes first due and payable
during the year after the adoption of the ordinance, adjust the
maximum permissible ad valorem property tax levy limits of the
district and the units participating in the district.
(d) If a unit by ordinance or resolution joins the district or elects to
have its public safety agencies served by the district, the department of
local government finance shall reduce the maximum permissible ad
valorem property tax levy of the unit for property taxes first due and
payable during the year after the adoption of the ordinance or
resolution. The reduction shall be based on the amount budgeted by the
unit for public safety communication services in the year in which the
ordinance was adopted. If such an ordinance or resolution is adopted,
the district shall refer its proposed budget, ad valorem property tax
levy, and property tax rate for the following year to the department of
local government finance, which shall review and set the budget, levy,
and rate as though the district were covered by IC 6-1.1-18.5-7.
(e) If a unit by ordinance or resolution withdraws from the district or
rescinds its election to have its public safety agencies served by the
district, the department of local government finance shall reduce the
maximum permissible ad valorem property tax levy of the district for
property taxes first due and payable during the year after the adoption
of the ordinance or resolution. The reduction shall be based on the
amounts being levied by the district within that unit. If such an
ordinance or resolution is adopted, the unit shall refer its proposed
budget, ad valorem property tax levy, and property tax rate for public
safety communication services to the department of local government
finance, which shall review and set the budget, levy, and rate as though
the unit were covered by IC 6-1.1-18.5-7.
(f) The adjustments provided for in subsections (c), (d), and (e) do
not apply to a district or unit located in a particular county if the county
fiscal body of that county does not impose an ad valorem property tax
levy under subsection (a) to fund the operation of the district.
(g) A county that has adopted an ordinance under section 1(3) of this
chapter may not impose an ad valorem property tax levy on property
within the district to fund the operation or implementation of the
district.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than one hundred
or a unit located in such a county.
(b) The ordinance establishing the authority must include an effective date and a name for the authority. Except as provided in subsection (c), the words "regional transportation authority" must be included in the name of the authority.
(c) After December 31, 2009, this subsection applies if a county is not a member of the northern Indiana regional transportation district
established under IC 8-24. The words "regional bus authority" must be
included in the name of an authority that includes a county having a
population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than
seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(d) After December 31, 2009, this subsection applies if a county is a
member of the northern Indiana regional transportation district
established under IC 8-24 and has a population of:
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven
hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than one hundred forty-five fifty thousand (145,000)
(150,000) but less than one hundred forty-eight seventy thousand
(148,000). (170,000).
In such a county the regional bus authority or regional transportation
authority, whichever applies, is abolished effective January 1, 2010.
After December 31, 2009, a regional transportation authority may not
be established by a fiscal body of such a county or a municipality in
such a county.
(b) A county or city described in subsection (a) shall become a member of an authority described in section 5(c) of this chapter if the fiscal body of the county or city adopts a resolution authorizing the county or city to become a member of the authority and the board of the authority approves the membership of the county or city.
(1) two (2) members appointed by the executive of each county in the authority;
(2) one (1) member appointed by the executive of the largest municipality in each county in the authority;
(3) one (1) member appointed by the executive of each second class city in a county in the authority; and
(4) one (1) member from any other political subdivision that has public transportation responsibilities in a county in the authority.
(b) An authority that includes a consolidated city is under the control
of a board consisting of the following:
(1) Two (2) members appointed by the executive of the county
having the consolidated city.
(2) One (1) member appointed by the board of commissioners of
the county having the consolidated city.
(3) One (1) member appointed by the executive of each other
county in the authority.
(4) Two (2) members appointed by the governor from a list of at
least five (5) names provided by the Indianapolis regional
transportation council.
(5) One (1) member representing the four (4) largest municipalities
in the authority located in a county other than a county containing
a consolidated city. The member shall be appointed by the
executives of the municipalities acting jointly.
(6) One (1) member representing the excluded cities located in a
county containing a consolidated city that are members of the
authority. The member shall be appointed by the executives of the
excluded cities acting jointly.
(7) One (1) member of a labor organization representing
employees of the authority who provide public transportation
services within the geographic jurisdiction of the authority. The
labor organization shall appoint the member.
(c) After December 31, 2009, this subsection applies if both a county
having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but
less than seven hundred thousand (700,000) and a county having a
population of more than one hundred forty-five fifty thousand
(145,000) (150,000) but less than one hundred forty-eight seventy
thousand (148,000) (170,000) are not members of the northern Indiana
regional transportation district established under IC 8-24. An authority
that includes a county having a population of more than four hundred
thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000) is
under the control of a board consisting of the following twenty-one (21)
members:
(1) Three (3) members appointed by the executive of a city with a
population of more than ninety eighty thousand (90,000) (80,000)
but less than one hundred five eighty thousand (105,000). four
hundred (80,400).
(2) Two (2) members appointed by the executive of a city with a
population of more than seventy-five eighty thousand (75,000) five
hundred (80,500) but less than ninety one hundred thousand
(90,000). (100,000).
(3) One (1) member jointly appointed by the executives of the
following municipalities located within a county having a
population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less
than seven hundred thousand (700,000):
(A) A city with a population of more than five four thousand one
nine hundred thirty-five (5,135) fifty (4,950) but less than five
thousand two hundred (5,200). (5,000).
(B) A city with a population of more than thirty-two twenty-nine
thousand (32,000) six hundred (29,600) but less than thirty-two
twenty-nine thousand eight nine hundred (32,800). (29,900).
(4) One (1) member who is jointly appointed by the fiscal body of
the following municipalities located within a county with a
population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less
than seven hundred thousand (700,000):
(A) A town with a population of more than fifteen sixteen
thousand (15,000) five hundred (16,500) but less than twenty
thousand (20,000).
(B) A town with a population of more than twenty-three
thousand (23,000) seven hundred (23,700) but less than
twenty-four thousand (24,000).
(C) A town with a population of more than twenty thousand
(20,000) but less than twenty-three thousand (23,000). seven
hundred (23,700).
(5) One (1) member who is jointly appointed by the fiscal body of
the following municipalities located within a county with a
population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less
than seven hundred thousand (700,000):
(A) A town with a population of more than eight fourteen
thousand (8,000) (14,000) but less than nine sixteen thousand
(9,000). (16,000).
(B) A town with a population of more than twenty-four thousand
(24,000) but less than thirty thousand (30,000).
(C) A town with a population of more than twelve sixteen
thousand five hundred (12,500) (16,000) but less than fifteen
sixteen thousand (15,000). five hundred (16,500).
(6) One (1) member who is jointly appointed by the following
authorities of municipalities located in a county having a
population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less
than seven hundred thousand (700,000):
(A) The executive of a city with a population of more than
nineteen twenty-five thousand eight hundred (19,800) (25,000)
but less than twenty-one twenty-nine thousand (21,000).
(29,000).
(B) The fiscal body of a town with a population of more than
(C) The fiscal body of a town with a population of more than five thousand (5,000) but less than
(D) The fiscal body of a town with a population of less than one thousand five hundred (1,500).
(E) The fiscal body of a town with a population of more than two thousand two hundred (2,200) but less than five thousand (5,000).
(7) One (1) member appointed by the fiscal body of a town with a population of more than thirty thousand (30,000) located within a county with a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(8) One (1) member who is jointly appointed by the following authorities of municipalities that are located within a county with a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000):
(A) The executive of a city having a population of more than
(B) The executive of a city having a population of more than
(C) The fiscal body of a town having a population of more than one thousand five hundred (1,500) but less than two thousand two hundred (2,200).
(9) Three (3) members appointed by the fiscal body of a county with a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(10) One (1) member appointed by the county executive of a county with a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000).
(11) One (1) member of a labor organization representing employees of the authority who provide public transportation services within the geographic jurisdiction of the authority. The labor organization shall appoint the member. If more than one (1) labor organization represents the employees of the authority, each organization shall submit one (1) name to the governor, and the
governor shall appoint the member from the list of names
submitted by the organizations.
(12) The executive of a city with a population of more than
twenty-seven thirty-one thousand four seven hundred (27,400)
twenty-five (31,725) but less than twenty-eight thirty-five
thousand (28,000), located within a county with a population of
more than one hundred forty-five thousand (145,000) but less than
one hundred forty-eight thousand (148,000), (35,000), or the
executive's designee.
(13) The executive of a city with a population of more than
thirty-three thirty-six thousand (33,000) eight hundred
twenty-five (36,825) but less than thirty-six forty thousand
(36,000), located within a county with a population of more than
one hundred forty-five thousand (145,000) but less than one
hundred forty-eight thousand (148,000), (40,000), or the
executive's designee.
(14) One (1) member of the board of commissioners of a county,
with a population of more than one hundred forty-five fifty
thousand (145,000) (150,000) but less than one hundred forty-eight
seventy thousand (148,000), (170,000), appointed by the board of
commissioners, or the member's designee.
(15) One (1) member appointed jointly by the township executive
of the township containing the following towns:
(A) Chesterton.
(B) Porter.
(C) Burns Harbor.
(D) Dune Acres.
The member appointed under this subdivision must be a resident
of a town listed in this subdivision.
(16) One (1) member appointed jointly by the township executives
of the following townships located in Porter County:
(A) Washington Township.
(B) Morgan Township.
(C) Pleasant Township.
(D) Boone Township.
(E) Union Township.
(F) Porter Township.
(G) Jackson Township.
(H) Liberty Township.
(I) Pine Township.
The member appointed under this subdivision must be a resident
of a township listed in this subdivision.
If a county or city becomes a member of the authority under section 3.5 of this chapter, the executive of the county or city shall appoint one (1) member to serve on the board.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than one hundred
(b) The taxing district of a public transportation corporation under this section includes all the territory inside the corporate boundaries of the two (2) cities in the county having the largest populations and such suburban territory as provided in section 13 of this chapter.
(c) This section applies upon the adoption of substantially identical ordinances approving subsection (b) by both:
(1) the public transportation corporation incorporating the additional territory; and
(2) the legislative body of the city being added to the taxing district of the public transportation corporation.
(d) Whenever the city in the county having the second largest population becomes a part of the public transportation corporation, then two (2) additional directors representing that city shall be appointed to the board of directors of the corporation. The directors must be residents of that city and are entitled to all of the rights, privileges, powers, and duties of directors under this chapter. The executive and the legislative body of that city shall each appoint one (1) director. These two (2) directors must not be of the same political party. The director appointed by the legislative body shall serve for a term of one (1) year, and the director appointed by the executive shall serve for a term of two (2) years. Upon the expiration of the respective terms, successors shall be appointed in accordance with section 18 of
this chapter.
(e) If the city in the county having the second largest population
appropriates money to support the public transportation corporation in
a particular year, and if the territory of that city subsequently becomes
a part of the taxing district of the public transportation corporation in
that year and is subject to a separate property tax levy for transportation
services, the maximum permissible levy of that city for the year
following the particular year used to compute the property tax levy
limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5 is decreased, and the maximum permissible
levy of the public transportation corporation for the particular year used
to compute the property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5 is increased,
by an amount equivalent to the current contract amount to be paid by
that city to the public transportation corporation for transportation
services provided to that city in the particular year.
(f) The public transportation corporation shall establish a single
property tax rate applicable to the taxing district of the public
transportation corporation, including the territory of the city in the
county having the second largest population that is included in the
public transportation corporation under this section. The initial
permissible levy to be raised by this rate equals the sum of the amount
raised by the levy of the public transportation corporation in the
previous taxable year plus an amount equivalent to the current contract
amount to be paid in the calendar year 1982 by the city in the county
having the second largest population to the public transportation
corporation. The permissible levy for the subsequent years shall be
computed in accordance with IC 6-1.1-18.5.
(g) If the city in the county having the second largest population is
excluded from the public transportation corporation in a subsequent
year, and that city is no longer subject to a separate property tax levy
for transportation services, the maximum permissible levy of the public
transportation corporation for that subsequent year used to compute the
property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5 is decreased, and the
maximum permissible levy of that city for that subsequent year used to
compute the property tax levy limit under IC 6-1.1-18.5 is increased,
by the amount of the product of the public transportation property tax
rate for that subsequent year multiplied by the assessed value in that
subsequent year of all taxable property in that city that is excluded from
the public transportation corporation.
under IC 6-1.1-41.
(b) As used in this section, "courthouse" includes a historical
complex consisting of a former county courthouse, jail, and sheriff's
residence which is open to the general public for educational or
community purposes in a county having a population of more than one
hundred seventy seventy-five thousand (170,000) (175,000) but less
than one hundred eighty eighty-five thousand (180,000). (185,000).
(1) A second class city located in a county having a population of more than one hundred
(2) Each municipality in a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000) in which the legislative body has adopted this chapter by ordinance.
(b) This chapter also applies to each second class city not in such a county in which the legislative body has adopted this chapter by ordinance.
(c) In addition, in a consolidated city, sections 9 through 38 of this chapter apply to the department of public works and the board of public works, subject to IC 36-3-4-23.
(b) The department is under the control of a board of sanitary commissioners, which is composed as follows:
(1) If the department is established under section 1(a) of this chapter, the board consists of not less than three (3) but not more than five (5) commissioners. All of the commissioners shall be appointed by the municipal executive, unless one (1) commissioner is the municipal engineer. Not more than two (2) of the commissioners may be of the same political party, unless the board consists of five (5) commissioners, in which case not more than three (3) may be of the same political party.
(2) Notwithstanding subdivision (1), if the department is established under section 1(a) of this chapter and the district
contains at least one (1) city having a population of less than one
hundred thousand (100,000) and at least one (1) town, the board
consists of one (1) commissioner from each municipality in the
district. The executive of each of those municipalities shall appoint
one (1) commissioner. If after all appointments are made the board
has fewer than five (5) commissioners, the executive of the
municipality with the largest population shall appoint the number
of additional commissioners needed to bring the total to five (5).
Not more than three (3) of the commissioners may be of the same
political party.
(3) If the department is established under section 1(b) of this
chapter, the board consists of not less than three (3) commissioners
but not more than five (5) commissioners. One (1) commissioner
is the city civil engineer. All other commissioners shall be
appointed by the city executive. Not more than two (2) of the
commissioners may be of the same political party, unless the board
consists of five (5) commissioners, in which case not more than
three (3) of the commissioners may be of the same political party.
However, if the department is located in a county having a
population of:
(A) more than one hundred five thousand (105,000) but less than
one hundred ten thousand (110,000);
(B) more than one hundred ten eleven thousand (110,000)
(111,000) but less than one hundred fifteen thousand (115,000);
(C) more than one hundred forty-eight seventy thousand
(148,000) (170,000) but less than one hundred seventy
seventy-five thousand (170,000); (175,000); or
(D) more than one hundred thirty twenty-five thousand
(130,000) (125,000) but less than one hundred forty-five
thirty-five thousand (145,000); (135,000);
and the city does not have a city civil engineer, one (1) of the
commissioners must be a licensed engineer, appointed by the
executive, with at least five (5) years experience in civil or sanitary
engineering. In addition, in such a city the commissioners may not
hold another public office. Not more than two (2) of the
commissioners may be of the same political party, unless the board
consists of five (5) commissioners, in which case not more than
three (3) of the commissioners may be of the same political party.
(c) Before beginning the commissioner's duties, each commissioner
shall take and subscribe the usual oath of office. The oath shall be
endorsed upon the certificate of appointment and filed with the
municipal clerk.
(d) Each commissioner shall also execute a bond in the penal sum of five thousand dollars ($5,000) payable to the state and conditioned upon the faithful performance of the commissioner's duties and the faithful accounting for all money and property that comes under the commissioner's control. The bond must be approved by the municipal executive.
(e) The appointed commissioners are entitled to a salary of not less than three thousand six hundred dollars ($3,600) a year during actual construction and not less than six hundred dollars ($600) a year in other years.
(f) Notwithstanding IC 36-1-8-10, whenever this section requires that the membership of the board of sanitary commissioners not exceed a stated number of members from the same political party, at the time of appointment the appointee must:
(1) have voted in the two (2) most recent primary elections held by the party with which the appointee claims affiliation; or
(2) if the appointee did not vote in the two (2) most recent primary elections or only voted in one (1) of those elections, be certified as a member of the party with which the appointee claims affiliation by that party's county chairman for the county in which the appointee resides.
(b) The ordinance adopting this chapter must specify the purpose or purposes for which the district is established, which must be one (1) or more of the following:
(1) To provide for the collection, treatment, and disposal of sanitary sewage and other water-carried wastes of the district.
(2) To provide for the drainage of storm and surface water to relieve sanitary sewers of that water.
(3) To reduce the pollution of watercourses in the district.
(4) To provide for the collection and disposal of trash, garbage, and solid waste.
If not all of these purposes are listed in the ordinance, one (1) or more of the remaining purposes may, by subsequent ordinance, be added to the purposes of the district.
(c) After adoption of the ordinance, three (3) interim members of the board shall be appointed for terms until the January 1 following the adoption. On the January 1 following the adoption, members shall be
appointed as provided in sections 3 and 4 of this chapter.
(d) Bonds of the district may not be sold without the prior approval
of the city legislative body. In addition, the legislative body must
approve all budgets and tax levies of the district.
(1) more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); or
(2) more than two hundred fifty thousand
(b) The board may secure temporary loans in anticipation of revenues of the district actually levied and in the course of collection for the fiscal year in which loans are made. The loans must be authorized by a resolution of the board, and the securities evidencing them shall be issued and sold in the same manner as tax anticipation warrants by second class cities in anticipation of property tax revenues as provided in IC 36-4-6-20. The temporary loans shall be evidenced by time warrants of the district in terms designating the nature of the consideration, the time or times payable, the funds and revenues in anticipation of which the warrants are issued and out of which they are payable, and the place where they are payable upon presentation on or after the date of maturity. The interest accruing on the warrants to date of maturity shall be included in their face value. The resolution authorizing the issue of the temporary loans must appropriate and pledge a sufficient amount of the current revenues in anticipation of which the warrants are issued for their payment.
(b) Except as provided in subsection (m), if the fiscal body of a unit has authorized the issuance of revenue bonds under this chapter, it shall, as long as the bonds are outstanding, establish and maintain fees with respect to the facilities for which the bonds are issued.
(c) The aggregate amount of the required fees must be sufficient to pay the cost of operation, repair, depreciation, and maintenance of the facilities, and to pay the sums required to be paid into the bond fund under this chapter.
(d) The ordinance may provide that the fees are payable:
(1) by either the users of the facilities, the owners of the property served by the facilities, or the unit; or
(2) by the users, owners, and the unit in the proportions fixed by the ordinance.
(e) Revenues collected under this section are considered revenues of the facilities.
(f) The fees may not be established until after a public hearing at which the users of the facilities, the owners of property served or to be served by the facilities, and other interested parties have an opportunity to be heard concerning the proposed fees and the provisions concerning payment of the fees.
(g) After introduction of the ordinance fixing the fees and providing for their payment, and before the ordinance is finally adopted, notice of the hearing, setting forth the proposed schedule of fees and the provisions concerning payment, shall be published in accordance with IC 5-3-1.
(h) After the hearing, which may be adjourned from time to time, the ordinance, as originally introduced or as amended, shall be passed and put into effect. A copy of the schedule of fees established shall be kept on file in the office of the board and in the office of the fiscal officer of the unit. The fee schedule is a public record.
(i) The fees or the provisions for their payment may be changed or readjusted in the manner by which they were originally established. However, if the change or readjustment is made substantially pro rata as to all classes of use or service, no hearing or notice is required.
(j) If:
(1) a user of the facilities; or
(2) an owner of property served by the facilities;
does not pay a fee within thirty (30) days after it is due, the amount of the fee, together with a penalty of ten percent (10%) and a reasonable attorney's fee, may be recovered by the unit in a civil action in the name of the unit.
(k) The unit is subject to the fees established under this chapter. The unit shall pay the fees when due. The payments are considered part of the revenues of the facilities.
(l) This subsection applies to a county having a population of more than
(m) If the fiscal body of a county that is subject to subsection (l) has authorized the issuance of revenue bonds under this chapter, the county executive shall, as long as the bonds are outstanding, establish and maintain fees with respect to the facilities for which the bonds are issued.
(b) The operation of city owned buildings or grounds operated as a golf course by a nonprofit corporation before July 1, 1995, without a lease from the city, or under a lease that was not open to public bid to lease the buildings or grounds, is legalized and validated.
(b) After the district is extended under section 5 of this chapter, the board consists of five (5) commissioners. Two (2) commissioners shall be appointed by the city executive, two (2) commissioners shall be appointed by the county executive of the county in which the city is located, and one (1) commissioner shall be appointed by a majority vote of the presidents of the school boards of the school corporations in the county in which the city is located. The commissioners appointed by the county executive must be residents of the area of the district outside the corporate boundaries of the city. The commissioners appointed by the county executive may not be members of the same political party, and the commissioners appointed by the city executive may not be members of the same political party.
(c) A commissioner of an extended district may hold office for an unlimited number of terms.
(d) After the initial terms have expired, all of the commissioners after the extension of the district shall be appointed for terms of four (4) years, beginning on January 1. The terms of office of the three (3)
commissioners in office at the time of the extension terminate January
1, and the terms of office of the new commissioners begin January 1.
The city executive shall appoint one (1) commissioner for an initial
term of two (2) years and one (1) for an initial term of four (4) years.
The county executive shall appoint two (2) commissioners, one (1)
commissioner for an initial term of two (2) years and the other
commissioner for an initial term of four (4) years. The presidents of the
school boards shall appoint one (1) commissioner for an initial term of
four (4) years.
(e) A vacancy in the office of a commissioner shall be filled for the
remainder of the term by the appointing authority.
(b) After the district is extended under section 5 of this chapter, the board consists of five (5) commissioners. Three (3) commissioners shall be appointed by the city executive, and two (2) commissioners shall be appointed by the county executive of the county in which the city is located. The commissioners appointed by the county executive must be residents of the areas of the district outside the corporate boundaries of the city. No more than two (2) of the three (3) commissioners appointed by the city executive may be members of the same political party, and the commissioners appointed by the county executive may not be members of the same political party.
(c) A commissioner of an extended district may hold office for an unlimited number of terms.
(d) All commissioners after the extension of the district shall be appointed for terms of four (4) years, beginning on January 1. The three (3) commissioners whose terms of office have not expired continue in office and are considered appointees of the city executive until the expiration of the four (4) year terms for which they each were originally appointed. The county executive shall appoint two (2) commissioners, one for a term of two (2) years and the other for a term of four (4) years. As the term of each commissioner expires, a new commissioner shall be appointed for a term of four (4) years so that at all times the board consists of three (3) commissioners appointed by the city executive and two (2) commissioners appointed by the county executive.
(e) A vacancy in the office of a commissioner shall be filled for the remainder of the term by the appointing authority.
(1) third class cities and towns, unless otherwise provided by law; and
(2) each second class city that:
(A) adopted second class city status by ordinance under IC 36-4-1-1.1, as a result of the 2010 federal decennial census; and
(B) has adopted all or part of this section by ordinance or resolution.
(b) As used in this section, "park authority" means:
(1) the municipal legislative body; or
(2)
(A) The governing body of the school corporation.
(B) A recreation board.
(C) The municipal works board.
(D) Any other appropriate board or commission.
(c) If a recreation board is established under subsection
(1) One (1) for a term of one (1) year.
(2) One (1) for a term of two (2) years.
(3) One (1) for a term of three (3) years.
(4) Two (2) for terms of four (4) years.
A vacancy shall be filled by the appointing authority for the remainder of the unexpired term.
(d) The park authority shall manage all public parks, including approaches, that belong to the municipality.
(e) If a municipality decides, by ordinance, to establish, lay out, or improve a public park or grounds, or to make an extension of a park or grounds, it may locate the park or grounds, including appurtenances, and it may lay out and open the public ways necessary for the improvement. If it is necessary to acquire land, water rights, or easements, or a pool, lake, or natural stream of water, the park authority may condemn that property and take possession of it if it is located within five (5) miles of the municipality. Before the park authority condemns the property, it shall assess the damages to the owners of the property at a meeting of the authority. Additional condemnation proceedings are the same as those provided for the taking of property to open streets.
(f) The park authority may adopt rules concerning the laying out, improvement, preservation, ornamentation, and management of parks. The park authority shall allow monuments or buildings for libraries, works of art, or historical collections to be erected in a park, as long as they are under the control of the persons in charge of the park and no inclosure separates them from the rest of the park.
(g) The legislative body of the municipality may also levy a tax on all taxable property in the municipality to pay for park property and for its improvement. The legislative body may also borrow money and issue the bonds of the municipality at any rate of interest payable annually or semiannually and may sell them for at least par value. The money derived from the sale of bonds may be used only for the purchase or improvement of parks. The legislative body shall annually levy a tax sufficient to pay the interest on the debt on all taxable property in the municipality to create a sinking fund for the liquidation of the principal of the debt.
(h) If the park authority of a city decides to lease any buildings or grounds belonging to the city and located in a public park when they are not required for public use, the proceeds shall be deposited with the city fiscal officer to the credit of park funds and devoted to the improvement of public parks.
(i) Any nonreverting fund that was created under IC 19-7-6 (before its repeal on September 1, 1981) continues until abolished by ordinance of the municipal legislative body. The legislative body may include in the park authority's annual budget an item and an appropriation for the specific purposes of a nonreverting capital fund. Money put in the fund may not be withdrawn except for the purposes for which the fund was created, unless the legislative body repeals the ordinance creating the fund. The repeal may not be made under suspension of the rules. Money procured from fees shall be deposited at least once each month
with the municipal fiscal officer. The fiscal officer shall deposit the
money either in a special nonreverting operating fund or in the
nonreverting capital fund as directed by the park authority. The
legislative body may provide by ordinance that expenditures may be
made from the special nonreverting operating fund without
appropriation. Money from fees procured from golf courses, swimming
pools, skating rinks, or other similar facilities requiring major
expenditures for management and maintenance may not be deposited
in this fund. Money from either fund shall be disbursed only on
approved claims that are allowed and signed in the same manner as
other claims of the municipality are allowed and signed.
(1) has a population of more than twenty-five thousand (25,000); and
(2) is located in a county having a population of more than
(b) A municipal board consists of four (4) members appointed by the executive of the municipality. A member shall be appointed on the basis of the member's interest in and knowledge of parks and recreation. The members may include the executive of the municipality and one (1) or more members of the municipal fiscal body. The ordinance creating a municipal board governed by this section may provide for one (1) or two (2) ex officio members.
(1) more than
(2) more than
(b) Notwithstanding IC 36-10-7.5-5, the department of parks and recreation of a township described in subsection (a) consists of four (4) members appointed by the township executive on the basis of the members' interest in and knowledge of parks and recreation. The members of a board governed by this section may include any of the
following:
(1) The township executive.
(2) One (1) or more members of the township board.
(3) Any other persons residing in the township.
(b) The governing body of a school corporation may annually appropriate, from the school corporation's general fund, a sum of not more than five-tenths of one cent ($0.005) on each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed valuation in the school corporation to be paid to a historical society, subject to section 6 of this chapter.
(b) To provide funding for a historical society under this section, the governing body of a school corporation may impose a tax of not more than five-tenths of one cent ($0.005) on each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed valuation in the school corporation.
(c) The school corporation shall deposit the proceeds of the tax in a fund to be known as the historical society fund. The historical society fund is separate and distinct from the school corporation's general fund and may be used only to provide funds for a historical society under this section.
(d) Subject to section 6 of this chapter, the governing body of the
school corporation may annually appropriate the money in the fund to
be paid in semiannual installments to a historical society having
facilities in the county.
(1) more than one hundred fifty thousand (150,000) but less than five hundred thousand (500,000);
(2) more than one hundred
(3) more than
(4) more than one hundred
(5) more than
(b) To provide funding for an art association under this section, the governing body of a school corporation may impose a tax of not more than five-tenths of one cent ($0.005) on each one hundred dollars ($100) of assessed valuation in the school corporation.
(c) The school corporation shall deposit the proceeds of the tax imposed under subsection (b) in a fund to be known as the art association fund. The art association fund is separate and distinct from the school corporation's general fund and may be used only to provide funds for an art association under this section. The governing body of the school corporation may annually appropriate the money in the fund to be paid in semiannual installments to an art association having facilities in a city that is described in subsection (a), subject to subsection (d).
(d) Before an art association may receive payments under this section, the association's governing board must adopt a resolution that entitles:
(1) the governing body of the school corporation to appoint the school corporation's superintendent and director of art instruction as visitors who may attend all meetings of the association's governing board;
(2) the governing body of the school corporation to nominate
individuals for membership on the association's governing board,
with at least two (2) of the nominees to be elected;
(3) the school corporation to use the association's facilities and
equipment for educational purposes consistent with the
association's purposes;
(4) the students and teachers of the school corporation to tour the
association's museum and galleries free of charge;
(5) the school corporation to borrow materials from the association
for temporary exhibit in the schools;
(6) the teachers of the school corporation to receive normal
instruction in the fine and applied arts at half the regular rates
charged by the association; and
(7) the school corporation to expect exhibits in the association's
museum that will supplement the work of the students and teachers
of the corporation.
A copy of the resolution, certified by the president and secretary of the
association, must be filed in the office of the school corporation before
payments may be received.
(e) A resolution filed under subsection (d) is not required to be
renewed annually. The resolution continues in effect until rescinded.
An art association that complies with this section is entitled to continue
to receive payments under this section as long as the art association
complies with the resolution.
(f) If more than one (1) art association in a city that is described in
subsection (a) qualifies to receive payments under this section, the
governing body of the school corporation shall select the one (1) art
association best qualified to perform the services described in
subsection (d). A school corporation may select only one (1) art
association to receive payments under this section.
(1) A flat charge for each system.
(2) Variable charges based on the capacity of a system.
(3) Other factors that the governing body determines are necessary to establish just and equitable rates and charges.
(b) In:
(1) a county having a population of more than four hundred thousand (400,000) but less than seven hundred thousand (700,000); and
(2) a county having a population of more than two hundred fifty
thousand (200,000) (250,000) but less than three two hundred
seventy thousand (300,000); (270,000);
rates and charges may be imposed or changed under this chapter only
after approval by the county legislative body.
(1) located in a county having a population of more than
(2) not served by a public library;
may pay the cost of a library card at the nearest library for a resident of the township upon request of the resident.
(1) has been established by a county or merged into a county public library;
(2) results from the merger of a public library into a county public library under IC 36-12-4;
(3) is located in part or all of two (2) or more townships and is not entirely located within the boundaries of one (1) municipality; or
(4) is located in part or all of two (2) or more municipalities.
(b) Subject to subsection (c), in a public library described in subsection (a), the appointments under section 9(4) and 9(5) of this chapter shall be made as follows:
(1) One (1) member appointed by the executive of the county in which the library district is located.
(2) One (1) member appointed by the fiscal body of the county in which the library district is located.
(c) This subsection applies to a county containing only two (2) Class 1 public libraries and having a population of more than one hundred
as follows:
(1) One (1) member appointed by the executive of the municipality
in which the principal administrative offices of the public library
are located.
(2) One (1) member appointed by the legislative body of the
municipality in which the principal administrative offices of the
public library are located.
(1) located in a county having a population of more than
(2) containing all or part of the territory of each school corporation in the county.
(b) Notwithstanding section 9 of this chapter, the library board has the following members:
(1) One (1) member appointed by the executive of the county in which the library district is located and who is not a member of the county executive.
(2) One (1) member appointed by the fiscal body of the county in which the library district is located and who is not a member of the county fiscal body.
(3) One (1) member appointed by the legislative body of the most populous city in the library district and who is not a member of the city legislative body.
(4) One (1) member appointed by the school board of each school corporation having territory in the library district and who is not a member of a governing body of a school corporation.
(c) An individual who is appointed under subsection (b) to serve as a member of a library board must, before March 1 of each year, report to the member's appointing authority concerning the work of the library board and finances of the library during the preceding calendar year, including the rate of taxation determined under IC 36-12-3-12.
(b) A municipal corporation receiving library service under section
7 of this chapter shall:
(1) levy a tax sufficient to meet the amount of compensation
agreed on under the contract; or
(2) make the contract payments with revenue derived from a tax
being imposed before the contract is approved by the municipal
corporation, including the part of local income tax revenue that is
not required to be dedicated to providing property tax relief.
(c) A library board providing service shall expend all funds received
under a contract for library services chargeable to the contract.
(1) "county fiscal body" means the fiscal body of a county in which a private donation library is located;
(2) "library board" means a library board established under IC 20-14 (before its repeal) or this article in a county in which a private donation library is located; and
(3) "private donation library" means a public library:
(A) established by private donation;
(B) located in a city having a population of more than one hundred
(C) that contains at least twenty-five thousand (25,000) volumes;
(D) that has real property valued at at least one hundred thousand dollars ($100,000); and
(E) that is open and free to the residents of the city.
(b) The library board shall:
(1) levy a tax under IC 6-1.1 in an amount not less than sixty-seven hundredths of one cent ($0.0067) and not more than one and sixty-seven hundredths cents ($0.0167) on each one hundred dollars ($100) of the assessed valuation of all the real and personal property in the county;
(2) keep the tax levied under subdivision (1) separate from all other funds of the library board; and
(3) use the tax levied under subdivision (1):
(A) if the membership of the trustees of the private donation library includes at least one (1) member or appointee of the library board and at least one (1) appointee of the county fiscal body, for distributions of the full amounts of the tax received to the trustees of the private donation library at the time the tax is received by the library board; or
(B) if the membership of the trustees of the private donation
library does not include at least one (1) member or appointee of
the library board and at least one (1) appointee of the county
fiscal body, at the discretion of the library board for:
(i) library board purposes; or
(ii) quarterly distributions to the trustees of the private
donation library.
(c) If requested by the trustees of the private donation library, the
library board shall designate a member of the library board or appoint
an individual to serve as a trustee of the private donation library. If
requested by the trustees of the private donation library, the county
fiscal body shall appoint an individual to serve as a trustee of the
private donation library.
(d) The trustees of the private donation library shall annually submit
a budget to the library board.
(e) The trustees of the private donation library shall expend amounts
received under subsection (b)(3)(A) or (b)(3)(B)(ii) for the support,
operation, and maintenance of the private donation library. The trustees
shall:
(1) keep the money separate from all other funds;
(2) record:
(A) the amount of money received;
(B) to whom and when the money is paid out; and
(C) for what purpose the money is used;
in a book kept by the trustees; and
(3) make an annual report of the matters referred to in subdivision
(2) to the library board.
(f) For purposes of the property tax levy limits under IC 6-1.1-18.5,
the tax levied by the library board under subsection (b)(1) is not
included in the calculation of the maximum permissible property tax
levy for the public library.